You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.
 
 
 
 
 
 

12007 lines
456 KiB

  1. \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
  2. @c %**start of header
  3. @setfilename openocd.info
  4. @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
  5. @dircategory Development
  6. @direntry
  7. * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
  8. @end direntry
  9. @paragraphindent 0
  10. @c %**end of header
  11. @include version.texi
  12. @copying
  13. This User's Guide documents
  14. release @value{VERSION},
  15. dated @value{UPDATED},
  16. of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
  17. @itemize @bullet
  18. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
  19. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
  20. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
  21. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
  22. @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
  23. @end itemize
  24. @quotation
  25. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
  26. under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
  27. any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
  28. Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
  29. copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
  30. Documentation License''.
  31. @end quotation
  32. @end copying
  33. @titlepage
  34. @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
  35. @sp 1
  36. @title OpenOCD User's Guide
  37. @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
  38. @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
  39. @page
  40. @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
  41. @insertcopying
  42. @end titlepage
  43. @summarycontents
  44. @contents
  45. @ifnottex
  46. @node Top
  47. @top OpenOCD User's Guide
  48. @insertcopying
  49. @end ifnottex
  50. @menu
  51. * About:: About OpenOCD
  52. * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
  53. * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
  54. * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
  55. * Running:: Running OpenOCD
  56. * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
  57. * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
  58. * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
  59. * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
  60. * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
  61. * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
  62. * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
  63. * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
  64. * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
  65. * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
  66. * General Commands:: General Commands
  67. * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
  68. * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
  69. * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
  70. * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
  71. * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
  72. * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
  73. * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
  74. * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
  75. * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
  76. @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
  77. @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
  78. @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
  79. @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
  80. * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
  81. * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
  82. @end menu
  83. @node About
  84. @unnumbered About
  85. @cindex about
  86. OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
  87. at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
  88. Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
  89. supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
  90. around the world.
  91. @section What is OpenOCD?
  92. @cindex TAP
  93. @cindex JTAG
  94. The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
  95. in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
  96. devices.
  97. It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
  98. a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
  99. electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
  100. required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
  101. usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
  102. needed to hook up to the target.
  103. Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
  104. each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
  105. different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
  106. are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
  107. they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
  108. These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
  109. may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
  110. Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
  111. let the development board connect directly to the debug
  112. host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
  113. For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
  114. signaling, and is used to communicate
  115. with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
  116. A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
  117. special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
  118. between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
  119. scan operations.
  120. There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
  121. signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
  122. adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
  123. debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
  124. For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
  125. special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
  126. support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
  127. (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
  128. @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
  129. USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
  130. OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
  131. @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
  132. ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
  133. (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
  134. Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
  135. @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
  136. CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
  137. internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
  138. STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
  139. controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
  140. @section OpenOCD Web Site
  141. The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
  142. @uref{http://openocd.org/}
  143. @section Latest User's Guide:
  144. The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
  145. available. A version for more recent code may be available.
  146. Its HTML form is published regularly at:
  147. @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
  148. PDF form is likewise published at:
  149. @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
  150. @section OpenOCD User's Forum
  151. There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
  152. which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
  153. anything to come to the attention of developers, you
  154. should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
  155. instead of this forum.
  156. @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
  157. @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
  158. The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
  159. communication between users:
  160. @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
  161. @section OpenOCD IRC
  162. Support can also be found on irc:
  163. @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
  164. @node Developers
  165. @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
  166. @cindex developers
  167. If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
  168. testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
  169. can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
  170. documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
  171. The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
  172. or expand the OpenOCD source code.
  173. @section OpenOCD Git Repository
  174. During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
  175. a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
  176. @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
  177. or via http
  178. @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
  179. You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
  180. @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
  181. With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
  182. a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
  183. There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
  184. with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
  185. needing a Git client:
  186. @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
  187. The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
  188. from the repository or a snapshot.
  189. Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
  190. @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
  191. Patches created against older versions may require additional
  192. work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
  193. @section Doxygen Developer Manual
  194. During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
  195. providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
  196. technical information about the software internals, development
  197. processes, and similar documentation:
  198. @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
  199. This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
  200. to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
  201. listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
  202. @section Gerrit Review System
  203. All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
  204. Code Review System:
  205. @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
  206. After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
  207. from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
  208. All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
  209. for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
  210. eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
  211. The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
  212. Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
  213. repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
  214. maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
  215. necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
  216. @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
  217. The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
  218. communication between developers:
  219. @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
  220. @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
  221. The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
  222. @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
  223. @node Debug Adapter Hardware
  224. @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
  225. @cindex dongles
  226. @cindex FTDI
  227. @cindex wiggler
  228. @cindex printer port
  229. @cindex USB Adapter
  230. @cindex RTCK
  231. Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
  232. an adapter .... [snip]
  233. In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
  234. attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
  235. @section Choosing a Dongle
  236. There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
  237. @enumerate
  238. @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
  239. OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
  240. other ways to communicate with target devices.
  241. @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
  242. Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
  243. @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
  244. Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
  245. wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
  246. @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
  247. Ethernet port needed?
  248. @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
  249. RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
  250. @end enumerate
  251. @section USB FT2232 Based
  252. There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
  253. on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
  254. known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
  255. See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
  256. In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
  257. chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
  258. variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
  259. (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
  260. clocking.)
  261. The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
  262. transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
  263. program some chips. They have two communications channels,
  264. and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
  265. other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
  266. Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
  267. a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
  268. @itemize @bullet
  269. @item @b{usbjtag}
  270. @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
  271. @item @b{jtagkey}
  272. @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
  273. @item @b{jtagkey2}
  274. @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
  275. @item @b{oocdlink}
  276. @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
  277. @item @b{signalyzer}
  278. @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
  279. @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
  280. @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
  281. bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
  282. the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
  283. These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
  284. to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
  285. @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
  286. @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
  287. Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
  288. Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
  289. Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
  290. @item @b{olimex-jtag}
  291. @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
  292. @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
  293. @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
  294. @item @b{turtelizer2}
  295. @* See:
  296. @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
  297. @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
  298. @item @b{comstick}
  299. @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
  300. @item @b{stm32stick}
  301. @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
  302. @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
  303. @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
  304. to be available anymore as of April 2012.
  305. @item @b{cortino}
  306. @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
  307. @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
  308. @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
  309. @item @b{digilent-hs1}
  310. @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
  311. @item @b{opendous}
  312. @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
  313. (OpenHardware).
  314. @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
  315. @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
  316. @item @b{GW16042}
  317. @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
  318. FT2232H-based
  319. @end itemize
  320. @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
  321. These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
  322. protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
  323. protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
  324. of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
  325. or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
  326. They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
  327. product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
  328. (see the section on driver commands).
  329. @itemize
  330. @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
  331. @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
  332. @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
  333. @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
  334. @end itemize
  335. @section USB J-Link based
  336. There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
  337. an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
  338. AT91SAM764 internally.
  339. @itemize @bullet
  340. @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
  341. @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
  342. @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
  343. @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
  344. @item @b{IAR J-Link}
  345. @end itemize
  346. @section USB RLINK based
  347. Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
  348. permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
  349. SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
  350. @itemize @bullet
  351. @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
  352. @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
  353. @item @b{STM32 Primer}
  354. @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
  355. @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
  356. @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
  357. @end itemize
  358. @section USB ST-LINK based
  359. STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
  360. They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
  361. @itemize @bullet
  362. @item @b{ST-LINK}
  363. @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
  364. @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
  365. @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
  366. @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
  367. @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
  368. @item @b{STLINK-V3}
  369. @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
  370. @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
  371. @end itemize
  372. For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
  373. its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
  374. The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
  375. @itemize @bullet
  376. @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
  377. @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
  378. @end itemize
  379. @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
  380. Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
  381. It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
  382. evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
  383. @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
  384. Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
  385. It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
  386. It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
  387. Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
  388. @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
  389. ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
  390. debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
  391. @section USB Other
  392. @itemize @bullet
  393. @item @b{USBprog}
  394. @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
  395. @item @b{USB - Presto}
  396. @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
  397. @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
  398. @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
  399. @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
  400. @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
  401. @item @b{Buspirate}
  402. @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
  403. @item @b{opendous}
  404. @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
  405. @item @b{estick}
  406. @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
  407. @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
  408. @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
  409. @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
  410. @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
  411. @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
  412. @end itemize
  413. @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
  414. The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
  415. and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
  416. these on the market.
  417. Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
  418. have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
  419. of USB-based ones.
  420. @itemize @bullet
  421. @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
  422. @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
  423. @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
  424. @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
  425. produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
  426. @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
  427. @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
  428. @item @b{Wiggler2}
  429. @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
  430. @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
  431. @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
  432. @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
  433. @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
  434. @item @b{arm-jtag}
  435. @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
  436. @item @b{chameleon}
  437. @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
  438. @item @b{Triton}
  439. @* Unknown.
  440. @item @b{Lattice}
  441. @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
  442. @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
  443. @item @b{flashlink}
  444. @* From STMicroelectronics;
  445. @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
  446. @end itemize
  447. @section Other...
  448. @itemize @bullet
  449. @item @b{ep93xx}
  450. @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
  451. @item @b{at91rm9200}
  452. @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
  453. @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
  454. @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
  455. @item @b{imx_gpio}
  456. @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
  457. @item @b{jtag_vpi}
  458. @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
  459. @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
  460. @item @b{jtag_dpi}
  461. @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
  462. Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
  463. interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
  464. emulation model of target hardware.
  465. @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
  466. @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
  467. @item @b{linuxgpiod}
  468. @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
  469. @item @b{sysfsgpio}
  470. @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
  471. This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
  472. @end itemize
  473. @node About Jim-Tcl
  474. @chapter About Jim-Tcl
  475. @cindex Jim-Tcl
  476. @cindex tcl
  477. OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
  478. This programming language provides a simple and extensible
  479. command interpreter.
  480. All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
  481. You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
  482. much of anything about Tcl.
  483. Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
  484. You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
  485. There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
  486. if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
  487. OpenOCD mailing list.
  488. @itemize @bullet
  489. @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
  490. @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
  491. which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
  492. fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
  493. implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
  494. 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
  495. @item @b{Missing Features}
  496. @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
  497. needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
  498. are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
  499. enabled in OpenOCD.
  500. @item @b{Scripts}
  501. @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
  502. command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
  503. Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
  504. @item @b{Commands}
  505. @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
  506. can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
  507. Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
  508. as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
  509. @item @b{Historical Note}
  510. @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
  511. before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
  512. as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
  513. to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
  514. @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
  515. @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
  516. @end itemize
  517. @node Running
  518. @chapter Running
  519. @cindex command line options
  520. @cindex logfile
  521. @cindex directory search
  522. Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
  523. to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
  524. in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
  525. that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
  526. @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
  527. complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
  528. are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
  529. Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
  530. tell it how each debug session should work.
  531. The @option{--help} option shows:
  532. @verbatim
  533. bash$ openocd --help
  534. --help | -h display this help
  535. --version | -v display OpenOCD version
  536. --file | -f use configuration file <name>
  537. --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
  538. --debug | -d set debug level to 3
  539. | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
  540. --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
  541. --command | -c run <command>
  542. @end verbatim
  543. If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
  544. OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
  545. To specify one or more different
  546. configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
  547. @example
  548. openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
  549. @end example
  550. Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
  551. @enumerate
  552. @item the current directory,
  553. @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
  554. @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
  555. @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
  556. @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
  557. @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
  558. @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
  559. @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
  560. @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
  561. @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
  562. @end enumerate
  563. The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
  564. @quotation Note
  565. Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
  566. include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
  567. @end quotation
  568. @section Simple setup, no customization
  569. In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
  570. libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
  571. your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
  572. start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
  573. customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
  574. If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
  575. target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
  576. the server with some variation of one of the following:
  577. @example
  578. openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
  579. openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
  580. @end example
  581. You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
  582. using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
  583. If all goes well you'll see output something like
  584. @example
  585. Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
  586. For bug reports, read
  587. http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
  588. Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
  589. (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
  590. @end example
  591. Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
  592. the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
  593. you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
  594. @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
  595. OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
  596. on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
  597. @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
  598. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
  599. At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
  600. chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
  601. ensure that this always succeeds.
  602. Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
  603. Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
  604. stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
  605. and then shut down without acting as a server.
  606. Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
  607. clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
  608. those channels.
  609. If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
  610. the @option{-d} option.
  611. Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
  612. @option{-c} command line switch.
  613. To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
  614. itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
  615. @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
  616. including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
  617. informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
  618. setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
  619. (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
  620. You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
  621. @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
  622. Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
  623. establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
  624. the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
  625. correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
  626. @node OpenOCD Project Setup
  627. @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
  628. To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
  629. just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
  630. and start the OpenOCD server.
  631. You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
  632. about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
  633. You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
  634. using Eclipse or some other GUI.
  635. @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
  636. Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
  637. (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
  638. and a USB cable on the other.
  639. Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
  640. older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
  641. @enumerate
  642. @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
  643. and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
  644. If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
  645. It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
  646. unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
  647. galvanic isolation between the target board and the
  648. debugging host.
  649. @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
  650. If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
  651. of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
  652. boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
  653. connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
  654. In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
  655. Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
  656. with 1.2 Volt boards.
  657. @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
  658. damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
  659. ways to connect the cable.
  660. Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
  661. Be sure it's firmly connected.
  662. In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
  663. prevent you from inserting it wrong.
  664. This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
  665. housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
  666. If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
  667. make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
  668. Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
  669. edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
  670. Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
  671. color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
  672. These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
  673. but are tedious to set up.
  674. Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
  675. adapter signals to the right board pins.
  676. @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
  677. A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
  678. you are using to run OpenOCD.
  679. For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
  680. For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
  681. does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
  682. Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
  683. MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
  684. @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
  685. This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
  686. but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
  687. @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
  688. Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
  689. you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
  690. so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
  691. @end enumerate
  692. Talk with the OpenOCD server using
  693. telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
  694. @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
  695. @section Project Directory
  696. There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
  697. A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
  698. single directory for your work with a given board.
  699. When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
  700. it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
  701. files accessed through semihosting,
  702. and for code you upload to the target board.
  703. It is also the natural place to write files,
  704. such as log files and data you download from the board.
  705. @section Configuration Basics
  706. There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
  707. a variety of ways you can mix them.
  708. Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
  709. @itemize
  710. @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
  711. @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
  712. in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
  713. @end itemize
  714. Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
  715. using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
  716. a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
  717. @example
  718. source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
  719. # GDB can also flash my flash!
  720. gdb_memory_map enable
  721. gdb_flash_program enable
  722. source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
  723. @end example
  724. Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
  725. @example
  726. openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
  727. -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
  728. -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
  729. -f target/sam7x256.cfg
  730. @end example
  731. You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
  732. each supporting a different development task.
  733. One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
  734. Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
  735. @quotation Important
  736. At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
  737. problems with how it treats variables.
  738. For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
  739. same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
  740. that can be tested in a later script.
  741. @end quotation
  742. Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
  743. file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
  744. to simplify your work.
  745. @section User Config Files
  746. @cindex config file, user
  747. @cindex user config file
  748. @cindex config file, overview
  749. A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
  750. in one place.
  751. One of the following will match your situation best:
  752. @itemize
  753. @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
  754. provided by someone else.
  755. For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
  756. (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
  757. Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
  758. user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
  759. where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
  760. The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
  761. Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
  762. own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
  763. @enumerate
  764. @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
  765. @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
  766. @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
  767. @end enumerate
  768. Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
  769. The first is an interface config file.
  770. The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
  771. their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
  772. declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
  773. meet your deadline:
  774. @example
  775. source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
  776. source [find board/csb337.cfg]
  777. @end example
  778. Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
  779. than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
  780. That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
  781. the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
  782. @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
  783. Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
  784. need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
  785. Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
  786. target and board
  787. configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
  788. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
  789. @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
  790. need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
  791. You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
  792. and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
  793. For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
  794. and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
  795. giving access to your particular flash chips.
  796. Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
  797. for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
  798. @quotation Note
  799. When you write new configuration files, please submit
  800. them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
  801. For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
  802. next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
  803. will help support users of any board using that chip.
  804. @end quotation
  805. @item
  806. You may need to write some C code.
  807. It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
  808. based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
  809. controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
  810. a new chip architecture.
  811. @end itemize
  812. Reuse the existing config files when you can.
  813. Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
  814. You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
  815. When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
  816. (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
  817. from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
  818. @itemize
  819. @item
  820. For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
  821. the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
  822. early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
  823. that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
  824. @item
  825. Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
  826. @cindex vector_catch
  827. its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
  828. and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
  829. during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
  830. Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
  831. along with messaging and tracing setup.
  832. (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
  833. @item
  834. You might need to override some defaults.
  835. For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
  836. work area if your application needs much SRAM.
  837. @item
  838. TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
  839. is environment-specific, and should only appear in
  840. a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
  841. @end itemize
  842. @section Project-Specific Utilities
  843. A few project-specific utility
  844. routines may well speed up your work.
  845. Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
  846. For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
  847. board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
  848. loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
  849. code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
  850. A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
  851. may help:
  852. @example
  853. proc ramboot @{ @} @{
  854. # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
  855. # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
  856. # Leave the CPU halted.
  857. reset init
  858. # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
  859. load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
  860. # Start running.
  861. resume 0x20000000
  862. @}
  863. @end example
  864. Then once that code is working you will need to make it
  865. boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
  866. Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
  867. (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
  868. based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
  869. @example
  870. proc newboot @{ @} @{
  871. # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
  872. # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
  873. # "reset halt" would be slower.
  874. reset init
  875. # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
  876. # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
  877. # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
  878. flash protect 0 0 1 off
  879. flash erase_sector 0 0 1
  880. flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
  881. flash protect 0 0 1 on
  882. # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
  883. reset run
  884. @}
  885. @end example
  886. You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
  887. from NAND.
  888. That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
  889. running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
  890. the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
  891. Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
  892. involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
  893. @section Target Software Changes
  894. Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
  895. you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
  896. For example, in C or assembly language code you might
  897. use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
  898. handling issues like:
  899. @itemize @bullet
  900. @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
  901. Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
  902. some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
  903. assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
  904. When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
  905. and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
  906. your debug sessions.
  907. It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
  908. needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
  909. That might however be your only option.
  910. Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
  911. while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
  912. that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
  913. need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
  914. damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
  915. involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
  916. at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
  917. and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
  918. protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
  919. that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
  920. it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
  921. instead of the whole thing.
  922. At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
  923. monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
  924. @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
  925. @cindex ARM semihosting
  926. When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
  927. toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
  928. @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
  929. ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
  930. The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
  931. your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
  932. provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
  933. It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
  934. helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
  935. for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
  936. NAND or SPI flash.
  937. @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
  938. Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
  939. Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
  940. Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
  941. via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
  942. You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
  943. or otherwise prevent using that state,
  944. to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
  945. polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
  946. registers which can be used to change various features including
  947. how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
  948. The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
  949. power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
  950. For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
  951. work for an idle processor otherwise.
  952. @item @b{Delay after reset}...
  953. Not all chips have good support for debugger access
  954. right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
  955. Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
  956. JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
  957. To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
  958. the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
  959. For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
  960. time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
  961. early code execution can be debugged
  962. or firmware can be replaced.
  963. @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
  964. Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
  965. Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
  966. (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
  967. operations like writing to memory.)
  968. Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
  969. over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
  970. provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
  971. various kinds of message.
  972. @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
  973. @end itemize
  974. @section Target Hardware Setup
  975. Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
  976. are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
  977. that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
  978. jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
  979. working with.}
  980. Common issues include:
  981. @itemize @bullet
  982. @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
  983. Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
  984. Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
  985. on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
  986. (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
  987. or one from a daughtercard).
  988. For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
  989. EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
  990. @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
  991. Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
  992. by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
  993. For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
  994. to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
  995. using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
  996. Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
  997. booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
  998. start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
  999. SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
  1000. flash; some external host; or various other sources.
  1001. @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
  1002. Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
  1003. to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
  1004. external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
  1005. a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
  1006. or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
  1007. board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
  1008. Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
  1009. configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
  1010. using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
  1011. @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
  1012. its @code{reset-init} handler.
  1013. A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
  1014. distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
  1015. used to start booting.
  1016. @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
  1017. Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
  1018. on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
  1019. multiple audio codec chips).
  1020. This interacts with software
  1021. configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
  1022. given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
  1023. or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
  1024. configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
  1025. signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
  1026. might in turn affect booting); others might control which
  1027. audio or video codecs are used.
  1028. @end itemize
  1029. Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
  1030. which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
  1031. That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
  1032. the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
  1033. memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
  1034. able to access those resources without working target firmware
  1035. which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
  1036. trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
  1037. bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
  1038. access to all board-specific capabilities.
  1039. @node Config File Guidelines
  1040. @chapter Config File Guidelines
  1041. This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
  1042. including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
  1043. needs to get a new board working smoothly.
  1044. It provides guidelines for creating those files.
  1045. You should find the following directories under
  1046. @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
  1047. them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
  1048. @itemize @bullet
  1049. @item @file{interface} ...
  1050. These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
  1051. specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
  1052. @item @file{board} ...
  1053. Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
  1054. contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
  1055. They reuse target configuration files, since the same
  1056. microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
  1057. but support for external parts varies widely. For
  1058. example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
  1059. of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
  1060. sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
  1061. board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
  1062. a CPU and an FPGA.
  1063. @item @file{target} ...
  1064. Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
  1065. on a chip
  1066. which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
  1067. are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
  1068. When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
  1069. the target config file defines all of them.
  1070. @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
  1071. For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
  1072. @end itemize
  1073. The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
  1074. file may override features in any of the above files by
  1075. setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
  1076. commands specific to their situation.
  1077. @section Interface Config Files
  1078. The user config file
  1079. should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
  1080. @example
  1081. source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
  1082. @end example
  1083. A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
  1084. in use today with OpenOCD.
  1085. That said, perhaps some of these config files
  1086. have only been used by the developer who created it.
  1087. A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
  1088. @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
  1089. Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
  1090. if you have a new kind of hardware interface
  1091. and need to provide a driver for it.
  1092. @section Board Config Files
  1093. @cindex config file, board
  1094. @cindex board config file
  1095. The user config file
  1096. should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
  1097. @example
  1098. source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
  1099. @end example
  1100. The point of a board config file is to package everything
  1101. about a given board that user config files need to know.
  1102. In summary the board files should contain (if present)
  1103. @enumerate
  1104. @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
  1105. @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
  1106. @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
  1107. @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
  1108. @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
  1109. @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
  1110. @end enumerate
  1111. Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
  1112. not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
  1113. handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
  1114. which it passes to target-specific utility code.
  1115. The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
  1116. @code{reset-init} event handler.
  1117. Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
  1118. configuration works.
  1119. @subsection Communication Between Config files
  1120. In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
  1121. board and target config files communicate is by following a
  1122. convention on how to use certain variables.
  1123. The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
  1124. Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
  1125. a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
  1126. used at will within a target configuration file.
  1127. Complex board config files can do the things like this,
  1128. for a board with three chips:
  1129. @example
  1130. # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
  1131. set CHIPNAME network
  1132. set ENDIAN big
  1133. source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
  1134. # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
  1135. # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
  1136. $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
  1137. # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
  1138. set CHIPNAME video
  1139. set ENDIAN little
  1140. source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
  1141. # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
  1142. # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
  1143. $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
  1144. # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
  1145. set CHIPNAME xilinx
  1146. unset ENDIAN
  1147. source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
  1148. @end example
  1149. That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
  1150. or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
  1151. or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
  1152. Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
  1153. where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
  1154. not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
  1155. is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
  1156. have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
  1157. Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
  1158. config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
  1159. naming collisions.
  1160. Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
  1161. For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
  1162. what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
  1163. up other clocks and peripherals.
  1164. @subsection Variable Naming Convention
  1165. @cindex variable names
  1166. Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
  1167. However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
  1168. one such chip (as shown above).
  1169. Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
  1170. variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
  1171. to promote consistency and
  1172. so that board files can override target defaults.
  1173. Inputs to target config files include:
  1174. @itemize @bullet
  1175. @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
  1176. This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
  1177. tap identifier dotted names.
  1178. While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
  1179. board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
  1180. @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
  1181. By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
  1182. Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
  1183. @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
  1184. When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
  1185. chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
  1186. The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
  1187. chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
  1188. @end itemize
  1189. Outputs from target config files include:
  1190. @itemize @bullet
  1191. @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
  1192. By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
  1193. script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
  1194. configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
  1195. specific to that board and that target.
  1196. If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
  1197. @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
  1198. @end itemize
  1199. @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
  1200. @cindex event, reset-init
  1201. @cindex reset-init handler
  1202. Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
  1203. they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
  1204. fully set up yet.
  1205. This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
  1206. you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
  1207. That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
  1208. handler is one of the most important.
  1209. Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
  1210. handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
  1211. Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
  1212. on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
  1213. handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
  1214. @quotation Note
  1215. Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
  1216. are included here.
  1217. Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
  1218. If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
  1219. configuration files for other JTAG tools
  1220. (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
  1221. @end quotation
  1222. Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
  1223. For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
  1224. much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
  1225. reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
  1226. those as parameters.
  1227. Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
  1228. and disabling the watchdog.
  1229. Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
  1230. the next developer doing such work.
  1231. (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
  1232. The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
  1233. whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
  1234. done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
  1235. access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
  1236. @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
  1237. Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
  1238. the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
  1239. a low JTAG clock rate.
  1240. @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
  1241. Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
  1242. made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
  1243. When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
  1244. because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
  1245. you should probably set it up in the board config file;
  1246. if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
  1247. For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
  1248. @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
  1249. is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
  1250. Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
  1251. which might be less than that.
  1252. @quotation Warning
  1253. On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
  1254. software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
  1255. Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
  1256. solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
  1257. @end quotation
  1258. If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
  1259. use the @command{jtag_rclk}
  1260. command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
  1261. also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
  1262. Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
  1263. and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
  1264. @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
  1265. @subsection The init_board procedure
  1266. @cindex init_board procedure
  1267. The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
  1268. (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
  1269. configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
  1270. (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
  1271. separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
  1272. everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
  1273. everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
  1274. Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
  1275. @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
  1276. so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
  1277. problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
  1278. need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
  1279. Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
  1280. the original), allowing greater code reuse.
  1281. @example
  1282. ### board_file.cfg ###
  1283. # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
  1284. source [find target/target.cfg]
  1285. proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
  1286. # enables fast on-board clock source
  1287. # configures the chip to use it
  1288. @}
  1289. # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
  1290. proc init_board @{@} @{
  1291. reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
  1292. $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
  1293. adapter speed 100
  1294. @}
  1295. $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
  1296. enable_fast_clock
  1297. adapter speed 10000
  1298. @}
  1299. @}
  1300. @end example
  1301. @section Target Config Files
  1302. @cindex config file, target
  1303. @cindex target config file
  1304. Board config files communicate with target config files using
  1305. naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
  1306. more target config files like this:
  1307. @example
  1308. source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
  1309. @end example
  1310. The point of a target config file is to package everything
  1311. about a given chip that board config files need to know.
  1312. In summary the target files should contain
  1313. @enumerate
  1314. @item Set defaults
  1315. @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
  1316. @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
  1317. @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
  1318. @item On-Chip flash
  1319. @end enumerate
  1320. As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
  1321. For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
  1322. which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
  1323. More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
  1324. config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
  1325. can talk to the chip.
  1326. For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
  1327. an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
  1328. another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
  1329. and other processing engines.
  1330. @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
  1331. All target configuration files should start with code like this,
  1332. letting board config files express environment-specific
  1333. differences in how things should be set up.
  1334. @example
  1335. # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
  1336. # but the default should match what the vendor uses
  1337. if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
  1338. set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
  1339. @} else @{
  1340. set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
  1341. @}
  1342. # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
  1343. if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
  1344. set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
  1345. @} else @{
  1346. set _ENDIAN little
  1347. @}
  1348. # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
  1349. # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
  1350. # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
  1351. if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
  1352. set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
  1353. @} else @{
  1354. set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
  1355. @}
  1356. @end example
  1357. @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
  1358. @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
  1359. config files, or the same target file multiple times
  1360. (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
  1361. Likewise, the target configuration file should define
  1362. @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
  1363. use it later on when defining debug targets:
  1364. @example
  1365. set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
  1366. target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
  1367. @end example
  1368. @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
  1369. After the ``defaults'' are set up,
  1370. add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
  1371. @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
  1372. for taps.
  1373. In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
  1374. probably for a CPU or FPGA.
  1375. The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
  1376. looks (in part) like this:
  1377. @example
  1378. jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
  1379. @end example
  1380. A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
  1381. to source such a config file twice, with different
  1382. values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
  1383. it adds a different TAP each time.
  1384. If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
  1385. OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
  1386. It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
  1387. can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
  1388. @example
  1389. JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
  1390. (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
  1391. ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
  1392. ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
  1393. ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
  1394. @end example
  1395. There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
  1396. multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
  1397. @itemize
  1398. @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
  1399. plus a JRC to enable them
  1400. @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
  1401. @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
  1402. is not currently used)
  1403. @end itemize
  1404. @subsection Add CPU targets
  1405. After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
  1406. GDB and other commands can use it.
  1407. @xref{CPU Configuration}.
  1408. For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
  1409. note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
  1410. to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
  1411. @example
  1412. set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
  1413. target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
  1414. @end example
  1415. Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
  1416. They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
  1417. and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
  1418. If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
  1419. a work area if you can.
  1420. Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
  1421. @example
  1422. $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
  1423. -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
  1424. @end example
  1425. @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
  1426. @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
  1427. @cindex SMP
  1428. After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
  1429. @example
  1430. set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
  1431. set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
  1432. target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
  1433. -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
  1434. target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
  1435. -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
  1436. #define 2 targets working in smp.
  1437. target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
  1438. @end example
  1439. In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
  1440. In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
  1441. @itemize @bullet
  1442. @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
  1443. @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
  1444. @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
  1445. @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
  1446. @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
  1447. displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
  1448. @end itemize
  1449. The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
  1450. command have been implemented.
  1451. @itemize @bullet
  1452. @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
  1453. @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
  1454. displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
  1455. session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
  1456. @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
  1457. @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
  1458. following example.
  1459. @end itemize
  1460. @example
  1461. >cortex_a smp_gdb
  1462. gdb coreid 0 -> -1
  1463. #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
  1464. #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
  1465. > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
  1466. gdb coreid 0 -> 1
  1467. #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
  1468. #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
  1469. > resume
  1470. > cortex_a smp_gdb
  1471. gdb coreid 1 -> 1
  1472. #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
  1473. #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
  1474. > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
  1475. gdb coreid 1 -> -1
  1476. #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
  1477. #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
  1478. @end example
  1479. @subsection Chip Reset Setup
  1480. As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
  1481. into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
  1482. chip can be tweaked by the board.
  1483. Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
  1484. managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
  1485. and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
  1486. For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
  1487. both signals.
  1488. Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
  1489. Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
  1490. letting this target config be used in systems which don't
  1491. provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
  1492. don't want to reset all targets at once.
  1493. Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
  1494. use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
  1495. or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
  1496. (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
  1497. driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
  1498. not available.)
  1499. Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
  1500. they're going to be used with JTAG.
  1501. An example might be needing to send some commands right
  1502. after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
  1503. @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
  1504. register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
  1505. Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
  1506. counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
  1507. JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
  1508. some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
  1509. are the right places to handle some of those issues.
  1510. For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
  1511. slower clock than they will use later.
  1512. That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
  1513. first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
  1514. than they will use later.
  1515. @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
  1516. @quotation Important
  1517. When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
  1518. reset, getting these issues right is critical.
  1519. In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
  1520. OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
  1521. look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
  1522. @end quotation
  1523. @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
  1524. @subsection The init_targets procedure
  1525. @cindex init_targets procedure
  1526. Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
  1527. configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
  1528. procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
  1529. (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
  1530. Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
  1531. This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
  1532. procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
  1533. a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
  1534. because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
  1535. @example
  1536. ### generic_file.cfg ###
  1537. proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
  1538. # basic initialization procedure ...
  1539. @}
  1540. proc init_targets @{@} @{
  1541. # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
  1542. setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
  1543. @}
  1544. ### specific_file.cfg ###
  1545. source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
  1546. proc init_targets @{@} @{
  1547. # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
  1548. setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
  1549. @}
  1550. @end example
  1551. The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
  1552. enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
  1553. For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
  1554. The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
  1555. (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
  1556. @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
  1557. @subsection The init_target_events procedure
  1558. @cindex init_target_events procedure
  1559. A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
  1560. @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
  1561. procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
  1562. (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
  1563. to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
  1564. events already assigned.
  1565. @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
  1566. If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
  1567. special high speed download features - enable it.
  1568. If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
  1569. Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
  1570. examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
  1571. activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
  1572. on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
  1573. through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
  1574. If you are using an external trace port,
  1575. configure it in your board config file.
  1576. If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
  1577. configure it in your target config file.
  1578. @example
  1579. etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
  1580. etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
  1581. @end example
  1582. @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
  1583. This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
  1584. @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
  1585. flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
  1586. Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
  1587. the TARGET (chip) file.
  1588. Examples:
  1589. @itemize @bullet
  1590. @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
  1591. @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
  1592. @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
  1593. @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
  1594. @end itemize
  1595. @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
  1596. @section Translating Configuration Files
  1597. @cindex translation
  1598. If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
  1599. or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
  1600. Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
  1601. it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
  1602. part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
  1603. sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
  1604. One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
  1605. Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
  1606. can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
  1607. convert other scripts later on.
  1608. Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
  1609. replace job:
  1610. @example
  1611. # Lauterbach syntax(?)
  1612. #
  1613. # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
  1614. #
  1615. # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
  1616. #
  1617. # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
  1618. proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
  1619. global TARGETNAME
  1620. echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
  1621. arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
  1622. [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
  1623. [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
  1624. @}
  1625. @end example
  1626. @node Server Configuration
  1627. @chapter Server Configuration
  1628. @cindex initialization
  1629. The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
  1630. used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
  1631. supported.
  1632. @anchor{configurationstage}
  1633. @section Configuration Stage
  1634. @cindex configuration stage
  1635. @cindex config command
  1636. When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
  1637. @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
  1638. certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
  1639. Normally, configuration commands are only available
  1640. inside startup scripts.
  1641. In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
  1642. presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
  1643. which may be issued interactively.
  1644. The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
  1645. commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
  1646. Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
  1647. flash banks,
  1648. the interface used for JTAG communication,
  1649. and other basic setup.
  1650. The server must leave the configuration stage before it
  1651. may access or activate TAPs.
  1652. After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
  1653. longer be issued.
  1654. @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
  1655. @section Entering the Run Stage
  1656. The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
  1657. stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
  1658. (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
  1659. It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
  1660. or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
  1661. You should see no errors at this point.
  1662. If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
  1663. commands you used to configure the server.
  1664. Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
  1665. fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
  1666. on the scan chain.
  1667. Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
  1668. become available.
  1669. A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
  1670. For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
  1671. a target has been successfully instantiated.
  1672. If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
  1673. entry to the run stage.
  1674. @deffn {Config Command} {init}
  1675. This command terminates the configuration stage and
  1676. enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
  1677. the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
  1678. programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
  1679. "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
  1680. command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
  1681. If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
  1682. OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
  1683. configuration files and/or command line options.
  1684. @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
  1685. openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
  1686. targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
  1687. read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
  1688. the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
  1689. @end deffn
  1690. @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
  1691. This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
  1692. to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
  1693. The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
  1694. which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
  1695. scan chain.
  1696. If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
  1697. from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
  1698. Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
  1699. they return.
  1700. This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
  1701. (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
  1702. @end deffn
  1703. @anchor{tcpipports}
  1704. @section TCP/IP Ports
  1705. @cindex TCP port
  1706. @cindex server
  1707. @cindex port
  1708. @cindex security
  1709. The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
  1710. Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
  1711. only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
  1712. For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
  1713. access using one or more of these ports.
  1714. In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
  1715. If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
  1716. use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
  1717. @anchor{gdb_port}
  1718. @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
  1719. @cindex GDB server
  1720. Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
  1721. communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
  1722. "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
  1723. the normal use cases.
  1724. No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
  1725. output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
  1726. disables the gdb server.
  1727. When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
  1728. output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
  1729. Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
  1730. Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
  1731. e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
  1732. The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
  1733. second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
  1734. When not specified during the configuration stage,
  1735. the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
  1736. When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
  1737. the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
  1738. @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
  1739. commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
  1740. @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
  1741. Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
  1742. gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
  1743. cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
  1744. @end deffn
  1745. @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
  1746. Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
  1747. connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
  1748. output from the Tcl engine.
  1749. Intended as a machine interface.
  1750. When not specified during the configuration stage,
  1751. the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
  1752. When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
  1753. @end deffn
  1754. @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
  1755. Specify or query the
  1756. port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
  1757. This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
  1758. When not specified during the configuration stage,
  1759. the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
  1760. When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
  1761. @end deffn
  1762. @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
  1763. @section GDB Configuration
  1764. @cindex GDB
  1765. @cindex GDB configuration
  1766. You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
  1767. The ones listed here are static and global.
  1768. @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
  1769. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
  1770. @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
  1771. @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
  1772. Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
  1773. This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
  1774. distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
  1775. GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
  1776. breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
  1777. @end deffn
  1778. @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
  1779. @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1780. Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
  1781. vFlash packet is received.
  1782. The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
  1783. @end deffn
  1784. @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1785. Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
  1786. requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
  1787. using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
  1788. for flash programming to work.
  1789. Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
  1790. @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
  1791. @end deffn
  1792. @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1793. Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
  1794. by GDB memory read packets.
  1795. The default behaviour is @option{disable};
  1796. use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
  1797. @end deffn
  1798. @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1799. Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
  1800. packets report errors or not.
  1801. The default behaviour is @option{disable};
  1802. use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
  1803. @end deffn
  1804. @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  1805. Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
  1806. The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
  1807. @end deffn
  1808. @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
  1809. Saves the target description file to the local file system.
  1810. The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
  1811. @end deffn
  1812. @anchor{eventpolling}
  1813. @section Event Polling
  1814. Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
  1815. where significant events can happen at any time.
  1816. The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
  1817. so it can report them to through TCL command line
  1818. or to GDB.
  1819. Examples of such events include:
  1820. @itemize
  1821. @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
  1822. a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
  1823. @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
  1824. targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
  1825. for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
  1826. @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
  1827. @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
  1828. can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
  1829. including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
  1830. @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
  1831. such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
  1832. or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
  1833. @end itemize
  1834. None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
  1835. However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
  1836. level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
  1837. Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
  1838. can imply events when those signals are inputs.
  1839. In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
  1840. either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
  1841. or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
  1842. to the various active targets.
  1843. There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
  1844. which is normally done in the background.
  1845. @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  1846. Poll the current target for its current state.
  1847. (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
  1848. If that target is in debug mode, architecture
  1849. specific information about the current state is printed.
  1850. An optional parameter
  1851. allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
  1852. You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
  1853. from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
  1854. Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
  1855. @example
  1856. > poll
  1857. background polling: on
  1858. target state: halted
  1859. target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
  1860. current mode: Supervisor
  1861. cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
  1862. MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
  1863. >
  1864. @end example
  1865. @end deffn
  1866. @node Debug Adapter Configuration
  1867. @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
  1868. @cindex config file, interface
  1869. @cindex interface config file
  1870. Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
  1871. OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
  1872. are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
  1873. @quotation Note
  1874. Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
  1875. places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
  1876. in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
  1877. limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
  1878. Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
  1879. specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
  1880. programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
  1881. @end quotation
  1882. Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
  1883. through commands in an interface configuration
  1884. file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
  1885. through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
  1886. @example
  1887. source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
  1888. @end example
  1889. These commands tell
  1890. OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
  1891. A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
  1892. @example
  1893. # jlink interface
  1894. adapter driver jlink
  1895. @end example
  1896. Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
  1897. @section Adapter Configuration
  1898. The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
  1899. using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
  1900. more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
  1901. @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
  1902. Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
  1903. target.
  1904. @end deffn
  1905. @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
  1906. List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
  1907. the running copy of OpenOCD.
  1908. @end deffn
  1909. @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
  1910. Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
  1911. The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
  1912. when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
  1913. the hardware can support.
  1914. @end deffn
  1915. @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
  1916. Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
  1917. @end deffn
  1918. @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
  1919. @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
  1920. Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
  1921. roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
  1922. @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
  1923. @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
  1924. The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
  1925. This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
  1926. @end deffn
  1927. @section Interface Drivers
  1928. Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
  1929. enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
  1930. available at run time.
  1931. @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
  1932. Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
  1933. connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
  1934. This defines some driver-specific commands:
  1935. @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
  1936. Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
  1937. the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
  1938. @end deffn
  1939. @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  1940. Displays status of RTCK option.
  1941. Optionally sets that option first.
  1942. @end deffn
  1943. @end deffn
  1944. @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
  1945. Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
  1946. This has one driver-specific command:
  1947. @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
  1948. Logs some status
  1949. @end deffn
  1950. @end deffn
  1951. @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
  1952. Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
  1953. presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
  1954. and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
  1955. @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
  1956. @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
  1957. @end deffn
  1958. @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
  1959. ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
  1960. or v2 (USB bulk).
  1961. @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
  1962. The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
  1963. the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
  1964. Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
  1965. @example
  1966. cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
  1967. @end example
  1968. @end deffn
  1969. @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
  1970. Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
  1971. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
  1972. @end deffn
  1973. @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
  1974. Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
  1975. @itemize @minus
  1976. @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
  1977. @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
  1978. @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
  1979. This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
  1980. @end itemize
  1981. @end deffn
  1982. @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
  1983. Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
  1984. In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
  1985. interface string or for user class interface.
  1986. @end deffn
  1987. @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
  1988. Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
  1989. @end deffn
  1990. @end deffn
  1991. @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
  1992. A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
  1993. @end deffn
  1994. @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
  1995. Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
  1996. @end deffn
  1997. @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
  1998. This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
  1999. Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
  2000. The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
  2001. bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
  2002. Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
  2003. configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
  2004. The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
  2005. define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
  2006. controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
  2007. are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
  2008. will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
  2009. @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
  2010. To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
  2011. SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
  2012. the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
  2013. required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
  2014. the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
  2015. Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
  2016. be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
  2017. nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
  2018. signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
  2019. @itemize @minus
  2020. @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
  2021. @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
  2022. @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
  2023. FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
  2024. @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
  2025. switching data and direction as necessary
  2026. @end itemize
  2027. These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
  2028. before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
  2029. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
  2030. The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
  2031. [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
  2032. @example
  2033. ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
  2034. @end example
  2035. @end deffn
  2036. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
  2037. Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
  2038. of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
  2039. during device selection.
  2040. @end deffn
  2041. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi serial} serial-number
  2042. Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
  2043. in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
  2044. is connected to the host.
  2045. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
  2046. (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
  2047. and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
  2048. @end deffn
  2049. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
  2050. Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
  2051. adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
  2052. @end deffn
  2053. @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
  2054. Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
  2055. Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
  2056. and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
  2057. schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
  2058. minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
  2059. and initially asserted reset signals.
  2060. @end deffn
  2061. @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
  2062. Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
  2063. GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
  2064. register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
  2065. buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
  2066. pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
  2067. used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
  2068. The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
  2069. not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
  2070. @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
  2071. with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
  2072. Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
  2073. simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
  2074. only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
  2075. driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
  2076. it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
  2077. @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
  2078. A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
  2079. same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
  2080. target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
  2081. input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
  2082. characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
  2083. are always driven by the FTDI.
  2084. If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
  2085. identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
  2086. @var{name}.
  2087. @end deffn
  2088. @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
  2089. Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
  2090. @itemize @minus
  2091. @item @option{0}, drive low
  2092. @item @option{1}, drive high
  2093. @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
  2094. @end itemize
  2095. @end deffn
  2096. @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
  2097. Get the value of a previously defined signal.
  2098. @end deffn
  2099. @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
  2100. Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
  2101. Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
  2102. peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
  2103. TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
  2104. stability at higher JTAG clocks.
  2105. @itemize @minus
  2106. @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
  2107. @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
  2108. @end itemize
  2109. @end deffn
  2110. For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
  2111. @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
  2112. @end deffn
  2113. @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
  2114. This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
  2115. FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
  2116. It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
  2117. List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
  2118. @itemize @minus
  2119. @item RXD(5) - TDI
  2120. @item TXD(1) - TCK
  2121. @item RTS(3) - TDO
  2122. @item CTS(11) - TMS
  2123. @item DTR(2) - TRST
  2124. @item DCD(10) - SRST
  2125. @end itemize
  2126. User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
  2127. commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
  2128. GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
  2129. They differ from physical pin numbers.
  2130. For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
  2131. Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
  2132. different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
  2133. that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
  2134. FT232R
  2135. @itemize @minus
  2136. @item bit 7 - RI
  2137. @item bit 6 - DCD
  2138. @item bit 5 - DSR
  2139. @item bit 4 - DTR
  2140. @item bit 3 - CTS
  2141. @item bit 2 - RTS
  2142. @item bit 1 - RXD
  2143. @item bit 0 - TXD
  2144. @end itemize
  2145. These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
  2146. before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
  2147. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
  2148. The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
  2149. 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
  2150. @end deffn
  2151. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r serial_desc} @var{serial}
  2152. Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
  2153. vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
  2154. the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
  2155. @end deffn
  2156. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
  2157. Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
  2158. If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
  2159. @end deffn
  2160. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
  2161. Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
  2162. @end deffn
  2163. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
  2164. Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
  2165. @end deffn
  2166. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
  2167. Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
  2168. @end deffn
  2169. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
  2170. Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
  2171. @end deffn
  2172. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
  2173. Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
  2174. @end deffn
  2175. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
  2176. Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
  2177. @end deffn
  2178. @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
  2179. Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
  2180. (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
  2181. set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
  2182. 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
  2183. byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
  2184. When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
  2185. Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
  2186. then kernel driver will not reattach.
  2187. If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
  2188. @end deffn
  2189. @end deffn
  2190. @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
  2191. Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
  2192. with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
  2193. instead of directly driving JTAG.
  2194. The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
  2195. processors which are being simulated.
  2196. @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
  2197. Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
  2198. sockets instead of TCP.
  2199. @end deffn
  2200. @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
  2201. Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
  2202. name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
  2203. @end deffn
  2204. For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
  2205. something like:
  2206. @example
  2207. adapter driver remote_bitbang
  2208. remote_bitbang port 3335
  2209. remote_bitbang host foobar
  2210. @end example
  2211. To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
  2212. named mysocket:
  2213. @example
  2214. adapter driver remote_bitbang
  2215. remote_bitbang port 0
  2216. remote_bitbang host mysocket
  2217. @end example
  2218. @end deffn
  2219. @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
  2220. USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
  2221. for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
  2222. configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
  2223. @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster device_desc} description
  2224. Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
  2225. of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
  2226. specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
  2227. if compiled with FTD2XX support.
  2228. @end deffn
  2229. @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
  2230. The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
  2231. default values are used.
  2232. Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
  2233. Altera USB-Blaster (default):
  2234. @example
  2235. usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
  2236. @end example
  2237. The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
  2238. @example
  2239. usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
  2240. @end example
  2241. @end deffn
  2242. @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
  2243. Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
  2244. (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
  2245. SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
  2246. target board.
  2247. For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
  2248. @example
  2249. usb_blaster pin pin6 s
  2250. reset_config srst_only
  2251. @end example
  2252. @end deffn
  2253. @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
  2254. Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
  2255. @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
  2256. configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
  2257. @end deffn
  2258. @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
  2259. This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
  2260. image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
  2261. @end deffn
  2262. @end deffn
  2263. @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
  2264. Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
  2265. This has one driver-specific command:
  2266. @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
  2267. Display either the address of the I/O port
  2268. (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
  2269. If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
  2270. This is a write-once setting.
  2271. @end deffn
  2272. @end deffn
  2273. @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
  2274. SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
  2275. transports.
  2276. @quotation Compatibility Note
  2277. SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
  2278. produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
  2279. but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
  2280. recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
  2281. available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
  2282. target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
  2283. released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
  2284. revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
  2285. "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
  2286. version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
  2287. @end quotation
  2288. @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
  2289. Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
  2290. states.
  2291. @end deffn
  2292. @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
  2293. Display free device internal memory.
  2294. @end deffn
  2295. @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
  2296. Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
  2297. command version.
  2298. @end deffn
  2299. @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
  2300. Display the device configuration.
  2301. @end deffn
  2302. @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  2303. Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
  2304. power state.
  2305. @end deffn
  2306. @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
  2307. Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
  2308. @end deffn
  2309. @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
  2310. Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
  2311. bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
  2312. IP configuration.
  2313. @end deffn
  2314. @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
  2315. Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
  2316. (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
  2317. @end deffn
  2318. @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
  2319. Reset the current configuration.
  2320. @end deffn
  2321. @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
  2322. Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
  2323. @end deffn
  2324. @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
  2325. Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
  2326. pairs.
  2327. The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
  2328. the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
  2329. @example
  2330. > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
  2331. @end example
  2332. @end deffn
  2333. @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
  2334. Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
  2335. pairs.
  2336. The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
  2337. @example
  2338. > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
  2339. 77a90000
  2340. @end example
  2341. @end deffn
  2342. @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
  2343. Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
  2344. to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
  2345. selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
  2346. the serial number instead, if possible.
  2347. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
  2348. @end deffn
  2349. @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
  2350. Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
  2351. connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
  2352. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
  2353. @end deffn
  2354. @end deffn
  2355. @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
  2356. This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
  2357. SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
  2358. families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
  2359. this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
  2360. @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
  2361. configuration script.
  2362. Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
  2363. mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
  2364. be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
  2365. switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
  2366. instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
  2367. Known limitations:
  2368. @itemize @bullet
  2369. @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
  2370. and 2.7 MHz.
  2371. @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
  2372. "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
  2373. not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
  2374. implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
  2375. versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
  2376. SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
  2377. communications with the target.
  2378. @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
  2379. version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
  2380. communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
  2381. disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
  2382. mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
  2383. could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
  2384. @end itemize
  2385. @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
  2386. Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
  2387. Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
  2388. @end deffn
  2389. @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
  2390. Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
  2391. device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
  2392. @end deffn
  2393. @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
  2394. Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
  2395. outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
  2396. target as a side-effect.
  2397. This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
  2398. @end deffn
  2399. @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
  2400. Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
  2401. version, and target voltage.
  2402. @end deffn
  2403. @end deffn
  2404. @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
  2405. Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
  2406. Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
  2407. These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
  2408. before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
  2409. @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
  2410. Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
  2411. This is a write-once setting.
  2412. Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
  2413. @itemize @minus
  2414. @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
  2415. @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
  2416. TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
  2417. @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
  2418. in configuration mode. This is only used to
  2419. program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
  2420. @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
  2421. @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
  2422. @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
  2423. @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
  2424. some versions of
  2425. Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
  2426. the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
  2427. @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
  2428. ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
  2429. This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
  2430. (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
  2431. @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
  2432. several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
  2433. @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
  2434. @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
  2435. @end itemize
  2436. @end deffn
  2437. @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
  2438. Display either the address of the I/O port
  2439. (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
  2440. If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
  2441. This is a write-once setting.
  2442. When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
  2443. @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
  2444. you may encounter a problem.
  2445. @end deffn
  2446. @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
  2447. Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
  2448. the parport driver uses this value to obey the
  2449. @command{adapter speed} configuration.
  2450. When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
  2451. that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
  2452. The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
  2453. However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
  2454. @quotation Tip
  2455. To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
  2456. oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
  2457. @example
  2458. > parport toggling_time 1000
  2459. > adapter speed 500
  2460. @end example
  2461. This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
  2462. the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
  2463. Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
  2464. You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
  2465. large set of samples.
  2466. Update the setting to match your measurement:
  2467. @example
  2468. > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
  2469. @end example
  2470. Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
  2471. command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
  2472. You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
  2473. that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
  2474. seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
  2475. toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
  2476. match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
  2477. be conservative.
  2478. @end quotation
  2479. @end deffn
  2480. @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
  2481. This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
  2482. cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
  2483. @end deffn
  2484. For example, the interface configuration file for a
  2485. classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
  2486. @example
  2487. adapter driver parport
  2488. parport port 0x278
  2489. parport cable wiggler
  2490. @end example
  2491. @end deffn
  2492. @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
  2493. ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
  2494. @deffn {Config Command} {presto serial} serial_string
  2495. Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
  2496. @end deffn
  2497. @end deffn
  2498. @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
  2499. Raisonance RLink USB adapter
  2500. @end deffn
  2501. @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
  2502. usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
  2503. @end deffn
  2504. @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
  2505. vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
  2506. @quotation Note
  2507. This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
  2508. which are not currently documented here.
  2509. @end quotation
  2510. @end deffn
  2511. @anchor{hla_interface}
  2512. @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
  2513. This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
  2514. This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
  2515. that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
  2516. Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
  2517. and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
  2518. ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
  2519. versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
  2520. using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
  2521. version reported is V2.J21.S4.
  2522. @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
  2523. Currently Not Supported.
  2524. @end deffn
  2525. @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
  2526. Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
  2527. @end deffn
  2528. @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
  2529. Specifies the adapter layout to use.
  2530. @end deffn
  2531. @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
  2532. Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
  2533. @end deffn
  2534. @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
  2535. @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
  2536. 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
  2537. @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
  2538. available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
  2539. ST-LINK server software module}.
  2540. @end deffn
  2541. @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
  2542. Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
  2543. passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
  2544. @end deffn
  2545. @end deffn
  2546. @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
  2547. @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
  2548. This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
  2549. (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
  2550. directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
  2551. The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
  2552. maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
  2553. (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
  2554. An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
  2555. @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
  2556. also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
  2557. @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
  2558. Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
  2559. 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
  2560. @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
  2561. available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
  2562. ST-LINK server software module}.
  2563. @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
  2564. @end deffn
  2565. @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
  2566. Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
  2567. @end deffn
  2568. @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
  2569. Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
  2570. @end deffn
  2571. @end deffn
  2572. @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
  2573. opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
  2574. @end deffn
  2575. @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
  2576. This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
  2577. @end deffn
  2578. @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
  2579. The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
  2580. LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
  2581. debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
  2582. following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
  2583. @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
  2584. Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
  2585. XDS110 found will be used.
  2586. @end deffn
  2587. @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
  2588. Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
  2589. XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
  2590. can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
  2591. @end deffn
  2592. @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
  2593. Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
  2594. version).
  2595. @end deffn
  2596. @end deffn
  2597. @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
  2598. This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
  2599. It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
  2600. fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
  2601. exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
  2602. For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
  2603. @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
  2604. Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
  2605. The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
  2606. of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
  2607. The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
  2608. @end deffn
  2609. @end deffn
  2610. @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
  2611. This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
  2612. exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
  2613. The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
  2614. for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
  2615. the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
  2616. able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
  2617. peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
  2618. configuration on exit.
  2619. See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
  2620. pinout.
  2621. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
  2622. Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
  2623. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
  2624. individually.
  2625. @end deffn
  2626. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
  2627. Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
  2628. specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
  2629. @end deffn
  2630. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
  2631. Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
  2632. specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
  2633. @end deffn
  2634. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
  2635. Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
  2636. specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
  2637. @end deffn
  2638. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
  2639. Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
  2640. specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
  2641. @end deffn
  2642. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
  2643. Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
  2644. specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
  2645. @end deffn
  2646. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
  2647. Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
  2648. specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
  2649. @end deffn
  2650. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
  2651. Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
  2652. specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
  2653. @end deffn
  2654. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
  2655. Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
  2656. to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
  2657. mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
  2658. @end deffn
  2659. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
  2660. Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
  2661. @end deffn
  2662. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
  2663. Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
  2664. @end deffn
  2665. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
  2666. Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
  2667. speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
  2668. @end deffn
  2669. @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
  2670. Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
  2671. 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
  2672. list can be found in the
  2673. @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
  2674. @end deffn
  2675. @end deffn
  2676. @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
  2677. i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
  2678. of the one which is most popular.
  2679. This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
  2680. See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
  2681. pinout.
  2682. @end deffn
  2683. @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
  2684. Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
  2685. The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
  2686. See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
  2687. @end deffn
  2688. @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
  2689. Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
  2690. Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
  2691. See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
  2692. @end deffn
  2693. @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
  2694. OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
  2695. This defines some driver-specific commands:
  2696. @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
  2697. Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
  2698. Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
  2699. @itemize @minus
  2700. @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
  2701. @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
  2702. (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
  2703. @end itemize
  2704. @end deffn
  2705. @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
  2706. The USB device description string of the adapter.
  2707. This value is only used with the standard variant.
  2708. @end deffn
  2709. @end deffn
  2710. @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
  2711. SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
  2712. JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
  2713. DPI server interface.
  2714. @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
  2715. Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
  2716. @end deffn
  2717. @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
  2718. Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
  2719. @end deffn
  2720. @end deffn
  2721. @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
  2722. This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
  2723. It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
  2724. Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
  2725. allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
  2726. @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
  2727. Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
  2728. @example
  2729. buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
  2730. @end example
  2731. @end deffn
  2732. @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
  2733. Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
  2734. @example
  2735. buspirate speed normal
  2736. @end example
  2737. @end deffn
  2738. @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
  2739. Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
  2740. @itemize @minus
  2741. @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
  2742. @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
  2743. @end itemize
  2744. For example:
  2745. @example
  2746. buspirate mode normal
  2747. @end example
  2748. @end deffn
  2749. @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
  2750. Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
  2751. to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
  2752. For example:
  2753. @example
  2754. buspirate pullup 0
  2755. @end example
  2756. @end deffn
  2757. @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
  2758. Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
  2759. which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
  2760. I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
  2761. @example
  2762. buspirate vreg 0
  2763. @end example
  2764. @end deffn
  2765. @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
  2766. Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
  2767. @end deffn
  2768. @example
  2769. buspirate led 1
  2770. @end example
  2771. @end deffn
  2772. @section Transport Configuration
  2773. @cindex Transport
  2774. As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
  2775. and the debug adapter you are using,
  2776. several transports may be available to
  2777. communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
  2778. @deffn {Command} {transport list}
  2779. displays the names of the transports supported by this
  2780. version of OpenOCD.
  2781. @end deffn
  2782. @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
  2783. Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
  2784. When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
  2785. transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
  2786. hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
  2787. adapter's driver).
  2788. If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
  2789. provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
  2790. supported by the debug adapter.
  2791. @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
  2792. transport, if any.
  2793. @end deffn
  2794. @subsection JTAG Transport
  2795. @cindex JTAG
  2796. JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
  2797. of the OpenOCD commands support it.
  2798. JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
  2799. each of which must be explicitly declared.
  2800. JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
  2801. Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
  2802. JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
  2803. jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
  2804. driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
  2805. or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
  2806. the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
  2807. @subsection SWD Transport
  2808. @cindex SWD
  2809. @cindex Serial Wire Debug
  2810. SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
  2811. Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
  2812. (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
  2813. SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
  2814. Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
  2815. (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
  2816. SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
  2817. swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
  2818. driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
  2819. or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
  2820. the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
  2821. @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
  2822. Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
  2823. Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
  2824. expected to change.
  2825. @end deffn
  2826. @deffn {Command} {swd wcr trn prescale}
  2827. Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
  2828. Wire Control Register (WCR).
  2829. No parameters: displays current settings.
  2830. @end deffn
  2831. @subsection SPI Transport
  2832. @cindex SPI
  2833. @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
  2834. The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
  2835. which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
  2836. solution for flash programming.
  2837. @anchor{swimtransport}
  2838. @subsection SWIM Transport
  2839. @cindex SWIM
  2840. @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
  2841. The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
  2842. by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
  2843. @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
  2844. SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
  2845. The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
  2846. The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
  2847. a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
  2848. virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
  2849. The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
  2850. @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
  2851. @anchor{jtagspeed}
  2852. @section JTAG Speed
  2853. JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
  2854. It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
  2855. only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
  2856. Sometimes the JTAG speed is
  2857. changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
  2858. reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
  2859. Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
  2860. oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
  2861. power management software that may be active.
  2862. The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
  2863. follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
  2864. target event handler.
  2865. It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
  2866. @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
  2867. CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
  2868. sets up those clocks).
  2869. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  2870. When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
  2871. because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
  2872. in the target config file.
  2873. When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
  2874. such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
  2875. config file instead.
  2876. In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
  2877. to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
  2878. clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
  2879. @example
  2880. jtag_rclk 3000
  2881. $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
  2882. @end example
  2883. If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
  2884. JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
  2885. However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
  2886. may not be the fastest solution.
  2887. @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
  2888. instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
  2889. which support adaptive clocking.
  2890. @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
  2891. A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
  2892. JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
  2893. speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
  2894. than the speed specified.
  2895. Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
  2896. The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
  2897. and is normally less than that peak rate.
  2898. For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
  2899. Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
  2900. @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
  2901. If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
  2902. JTAG clocking after setup.
  2903. Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
  2904. If the interface device can not
  2905. support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
  2906. @end deffn
  2907. @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
  2908. @cindex adaptive clocking
  2909. @cindex RTCK
  2910. This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
  2911. If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
  2912. support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
  2913. @example
  2914. # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
  2915. jtag_rclk 3000
  2916. @end example
  2917. @end defun
  2918. @node Reset Configuration
  2919. @chapter Reset Configuration
  2920. @cindex Reset Configuration
  2921. Every system configuration may require a different reset
  2922. configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
  2923. Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
  2924. which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
  2925. JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
  2926. They can also interact with JTAG routers.
  2927. Please see the various board files for examples.
  2928. @quotation Note
  2929. To maintainers and integrators:
  2930. Reset configuration touches several things at once.
  2931. Normally the board configuration file
  2932. should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
  2933. everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
  2934. However, the target configuration file could also make note
  2935. of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
  2936. which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
  2937. And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
  2938. user configuration file will need to override parts of
  2939. the reset configuration provided by other files.
  2940. @end quotation
  2941. @section Types of Reset
  2942. There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
  2943. they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
  2944. That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
  2945. @itemize @bullet
  2946. @item
  2947. @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
  2948. resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
  2949. power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
  2950. with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
  2951. @item
  2952. @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
  2953. just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
  2954. Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
  2955. device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
  2956. @item
  2957. @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
  2958. commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
  2959. resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
  2960. or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
  2961. @item
  2962. @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
  2963. several other types of reset.
  2964. You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
  2965. while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
  2966. There may be individual module resets.
  2967. @end itemize
  2968. In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
  2969. the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
  2970. CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
  2971. Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
  2972. halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
  2973. This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
  2974. and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
  2975. board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
  2976. (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
  2977. @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
  2978. @section SRST and TRST Issues
  2979. Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
  2980. variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
  2981. common issues are:
  2982. @itemize @bullet
  2983. @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
  2984. SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
  2985. support such signals even if they are wired up.
  2986. Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
  2987. when either of those signals is not connected.
  2988. When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
  2989. on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
  2990. Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
  2991. be triggered using with TMS signaling.
  2992. @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
  2993. adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
  2994. Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
  2995. when those signals aren't properly independent.
  2996. @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
  2997. delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
  2998. the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
  2999. stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
  3000. requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
  3001. certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
  3002. hardware debouncing.
  3003. Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
  3004. commands to say when extra delays are needed.
  3005. @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
  3006. resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
  3007. signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
  3008. to use push/pull output drivers.
  3009. Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
  3010. signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
  3011. Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
  3012. @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
  3013. @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
  3014. special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
  3015. issues (not limited to errata).
  3016. For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
  3017. the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
  3018. but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
  3019. Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
  3020. trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
  3021. Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
  3022. @end itemize
  3023. There can also be other issues.
  3024. Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
  3025. Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
  3026. SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
  3027. There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
  3028. their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
  3029. Agreement (NDA).
  3030. Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
  3031. the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
  3032. don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
  3033. In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
  3034. needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
  3035. @section Commands for Handling Resets
  3036. @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
  3037. Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
  3038. after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
  3039. allowing it to be deasserted.
  3040. @end deffn
  3041. @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
  3042. How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
  3043. nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
  3044. When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
  3045. probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
  3046. @end deffn
  3047. @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
  3048. Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
  3049. after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
  3050. allowing it to be deasserted.
  3051. @end deffn
  3052. @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
  3053. How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
  3054. nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
  3055. @end deffn
  3056. @anchor{reset_config}
  3057. @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
  3058. This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
  3059. of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
  3060. configuration scripts.
  3061. Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
  3062. the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
  3063. As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
  3064. describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
  3065. or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
  3066. from a particular combination of interface and board.
  3067. (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
  3068. with a board that only wires up SRST.)
  3069. The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
  3070. of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
  3071. @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
  3072. -- may be specified at a time.
  3073. If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
  3074. value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
  3075. For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
  3076. TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
  3077. it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
  3078. @itemize
  3079. @item
  3080. @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
  3081. For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
  3082. connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
  3083. Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
  3084. @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
  3085. @quotation Tip
  3086. If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
  3087. you must declare that so those signals can be used.
  3088. @end quotation
  3089. @item
  3090. The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
  3091. signal implementations.
  3092. The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
  3093. indicating everything behaves normally.
  3094. @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
  3095. test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
  3096. LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
  3097. the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
  3098. haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
  3099. @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
  3100. @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
  3101. @item
  3102. The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
  3103. JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
  3104. @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
  3105. indicates that asserting SRST gates the
  3106. JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
  3107. while SRST is asserted.
  3108. Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
  3109. can safely be issued while SRST is active.
  3110. @item
  3111. The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
  3112. SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
  3113. is required to use this option.
  3114. @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
  3115. indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
  3116. Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
  3117. be asserted before any target connection.
  3118. Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
  3119. This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
  3120. to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
  3121. @end itemize
  3122. The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
  3123. driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
  3124. JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
  3125. JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
  3126. relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
  3127. @itemize
  3128. @item
  3129. Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
  3130. are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
  3131. Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
  3132. never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
  3133. @item
  3134. Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
  3135. are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
  3136. Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
  3137. signal to be pulled low by various events including system
  3138. power-up and pressing a reset button.
  3139. @end itemize
  3140. @end deffn
  3141. @section Custom Reset Handling
  3142. @cindex events
  3143. OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
  3144. mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
  3145. The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
  3146. There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
  3147. Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
  3148. at particular points in the reset sequence.
  3149. @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
  3150. up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
  3151. For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
  3152. and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
  3153. want to reset everything at once.
  3154. After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
  3155. find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
  3156. For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
  3157. of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
  3158. the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
  3159. or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
  3160. needs special attention.
  3161. Experiment with lower level operations, such as
  3162. @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
  3163. and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
  3164. to find a sequence of operations that works.
  3165. @xref{JTAG Commands}.
  3166. When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
  3167. @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
  3168. (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
  3169. or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
  3170. You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
  3171. schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
  3172. @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
  3173. may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
  3174. thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
  3175. @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
  3176. This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
  3177. usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
  3178. By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
  3179. the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
  3180. The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
  3181. low level reset command (@option{halt},
  3182. @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
  3183. or potentially some other value.
  3184. The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
  3185. Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
  3186. operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
  3187. Operations here must not address individual TAPs
  3188. (or their associated targets)
  3189. until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
  3190. Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
  3191. they return.
  3192. This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
  3193. (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
  3194. @end deffn
  3195. @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
  3196. This validates the scan chain using just the four
  3197. standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
  3198. It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
  3199. Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
  3200. matches the TAPs it can observe.
  3201. Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
  3202. and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
  3203. TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
  3204. If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
  3205. issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
  3206. @end deffn
  3207. @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
  3208. This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
  3209. everything on the JTAG scan chain
  3210. (and anything else connected to SRST).
  3211. It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
  3212. @end deffn
  3213. @node TAP Declaration
  3214. @chapter TAP Declaration
  3215. @cindex TAP declaration
  3216. @cindex TAP configuration
  3217. @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
  3218. TAPs serve many roles, including:
  3219. @itemize @bullet
  3220. @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
  3221. @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
  3222. Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
  3223. @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
  3224. you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
  3225. start running that code.
  3226. @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
  3227. helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
  3228. and missing connections.
  3229. @end itemize
  3230. OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
  3231. Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
  3232. Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
  3233. which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
  3234. probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
  3235. @section Scan Chains
  3236. @cindex scan chain
  3237. TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
  3238. which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
  3239. They also need to be added to
  3240. OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
  3241. giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
  3242. Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
  3243. systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
  3244. More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
  3245. Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
  3246. several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
  3247. to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
  3248. You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
  3249. (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
  3250. command, presented in the next chapter.
  3251. That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
  3252. debugging targets.)
  3253. Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
  3254. @verbatim
  3255. TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
  3256. -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
  3257. 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
  3258. 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
  3259. 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
  3260. @end verbatim
  3261. OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
  3262. of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
  3263. Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
  3264. because not all devices provide good support for that.
  3265. JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
  3266. chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
  3267. until they are told to do so.
  3268. The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
  3269. requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
  3270. @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
  3271. A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
  3272. @example
  3273. jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
  3274. @end example
  3275. Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
  3276. by a given chip.
  3277. Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
  3278. and so forth.
  3279. Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
  3280. That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
  3281. both inside a single chip and between them.
  3282. @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
  3283. For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
  3284. three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
  3285. document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
  3286. 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
  3287. @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
  3288. To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
  3289. includes commands something like this:
  3290. @example
  3291. jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
  3292. jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
  3293. jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
  3294. @end example
  3295. Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
  3296. instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
  3297. of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
  3298. @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
  3299. Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
  3300. Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
  3301. to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
  3302. @example
  3303. foreach t [jtag names] @{
  3304. puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
  3305. @}
  3306. @end example
  3307. @end deffn
  3308. @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
  3309. Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
  3310. and their status.
  3311. The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
  3312. exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
  3313. but systems with a JTAG router can
  3314. enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
  3315. @end deffn
  3316. @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
  3317. @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
  3318. @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
  3319. @c (on entry to RESET state).
  3320. @section TAP Names
  3321. @cindex dotted name
  3322. When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
  3323. a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
  3324. name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
  3325. For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
  3326. @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
  3327. Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
  3328. refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
  3329. name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
  3330. The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
  3331. name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
  3332. and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
  3333. @section TAP Declaration Commands
  3334. @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
  3335. Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
  3336. and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
  3337. The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
  3338. Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
  3339. defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
  3340. overridable.
  3341. @cindex TAP naming convention
  3342. The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
  3343. and should follow this convention:
  3344. @itemize @bullet
  3345. @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
  3346. @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
  3347. @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
  3348. @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
  3349. @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
  3350. @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
  3351. @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
  3352. on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
  3353. @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
  3354. with a single TAP;
  3355. @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
  3356. @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
  3357. For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
  3358. a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
  3359. @end itemize
  3360. Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
  3361. @itemize @bullet
  3362. @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
  3363. @*The length in bits of the
  3364. instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
  3365. @end itemize
  3366. A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
  3367. @itemize @bullet
  3368. @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
  3369. @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
  3370. linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
  3371. or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
  3372. You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
  3373. (the TAP is linked in).
  3374. @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
  3375. @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
  3376. @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
  3377. which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
  3378. These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
  3379. @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
  3380. ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
  3381. Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
  3382. values that were found but not included in the list.
  3383. Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
  3384. tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
  3385. are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
  3386. reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
  3387. hardware to find these values.
  3388. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
  3389. @item @code{-ignore-version}
  3390. @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
  3391. option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
  3392. JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
  3393. to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
  3394. the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
  3395. @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
  3396. @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
  3397. on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
  3398. JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
  3399. By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
  3400. up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
  3401. additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
  3402. a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
  3403. @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
  3404. @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
  3405. to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
  3406. Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
  3407. there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
  3408. @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
  3409. @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
  3410. register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
  3411. This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
  3412. devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
  3413. @end itemize
  3414. @end deffn
  3415. @section Other TAP commands
  3416. @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
  3417. Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
  3418. @end deffn
  3419. @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
  3420. @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
  3421. At this writing this TAP attribute
  3422. mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
  3423. (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
  3424. mechanism for debugger targets.)
  3425. See the next section for information about the available events.
  3426. The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
  3427. a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
  3428. The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
  3429. @end deffn
  3430. @section TAP Events
  3431. @cindex events
  3432. @cindex TAP events
  3433. OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
  3434. The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
  3435. The other applies to debugger targets,
  3436. which are associated with certain TAPs.
  3437. The TAP events currently defined are:
  3438. @itemize @bullet
  3439. @item @b{post-reset}
  3440. @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
  3441. The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
  3442. Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
  3443. such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
  3444. exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
  3445. Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
  3446. @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
  3447. of any particular target.
  3448. @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
  3449. @item @b{setup}
  3450. @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
  3451. This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
  3452. @item @b{tap-disable}
  3453. @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
  3454. implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
  3455. by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
  3456. @item @b{tap-enable}
  3457. @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
  3458. implement @command{jtag tapenable}
  3459. by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
  3460. @end itemize
  3461. If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
  3462. specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
  3463. contents to be accurate), you might:
  3464. @example
  3465. jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
  3466. echo "JTAG Reset done"
  3467. ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
  3468. @}
  3469. @end example
  3470. @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
  3471. @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
  3472. @cindex JTAG Route Controller
  3473. @cindex jrc
  3474. In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
  3475. is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
  3476. Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
  3477. an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
  3478. Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
  3479. A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
  3480. told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
  3481. has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
  3482. be visible.
  3483. Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
  3484. ignores, such as:
  3485. @itemize
  3486. @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
  3487. @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
  3488. TAPs receive new instructions.
  3489. @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
  3490. power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
  3491. @end itemize
  3492. The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
  3493. as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
  3494. However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
  3495. does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
  3496. @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
  3497. @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
  3498. In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
  3499. shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
  3500. So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
  3501. a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
  3502. should define TAP event handlers using
  3503. code that looks something like this:
  3504. @example
  3505. jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
  3506. ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
  3507. @}
  3508. jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
  3509. ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
  3510. @}
  3511. @end example
  3512. Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
  3513. @example
  3514. jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
  3515. @end example
  3516. Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
  3517. uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
  3518. Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
  3519. at runtime, when it might have a different value.
  3520. @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
  3521. If necessary, disables the tap
  3522. by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
  3523. Returns the string "1" if the tap
  3524. specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
  3525. and "0" if it is disabled.
  3526. @end deffn
  3527. @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
  3528. If necessary, enables the tap
  3529. by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
  3530. Returns the string "1" if the tap
  3531. specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
  3532. and "0" if it is disabled.
  3533. @end deffn
  3534. @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
  3535. Returns the string "1" if the tap
  3536. specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
  3537. and "0" if it is disabled.
  3538. @quotation Note
  3539. Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
  3540. for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
  3541. @end quotation
  3542. @end deffn
  3543. @anchor{autoprobing}
  3544. @section Autoprobing
  3545. @cindex autoprobe
  3546. @cindex JTAG autoprobe
  3547. TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
  3548. after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
  3549. hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
  3550. Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
  3551. To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
  3552. @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
  3553. a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
  3554. To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
  3555. that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
  3556. with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
  3557. right when they come out of reset).
  3558. For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
  3559. @example
  3560. source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
  3561. reset_config trst_and_srst
  3562. jtag_rclk 8
  3563. @end example
  3564. When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
  3565. attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
  3566. @enumerate
  3567. @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
  3568. After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
  3569. each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
  3570. IDCODE or BYPASS register.
  3571. If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
  3572. and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
  3573. @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
  3574. Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
  3575. the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
  3576. that is discovered.
  3577. If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
  3578. register, it will report it.
  3579. Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
  3580. as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
  3581. @end enumerate
  3582. In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
  3583. a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
  3584. that's a bit more complex:
  3585. @example
  3586. clock speed 8 kHz
  3587. There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
  3588. AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
  3589. AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
  3590. AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
  3591. AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
  3592. AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
  3593. AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
  3594. no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
  3595. @end example
  3596. Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
  3597. config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
  3598. would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
  3599. with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
  3600. resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
  3601. and so forth.
  3602. @anchor{dapdeclaration}
  3603. @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
  3604. @cindex DAP declaration
  3605. Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
  3606. no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
  3607. explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
  3608. and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
  3609. instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
  3610. The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
  3611. @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
  3612. Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
  3613. @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
  3614. which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
  3615. There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
  3616. A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
  3617. @itemize @bullet
  3618. @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
  3619. @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
  3620. register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
  3621. This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
  3622. devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
  3623. @end itemize
  3624. @end deffn
  3625. @deffn {Command} {dap names}
  3626. This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
  3627. for TCL scripting.
  3628. @end deffn
  3629. @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
  3630. Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
  3631. defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
  3632. @end deffn
  3633. @deffn {Command} {dap init}
  3634. Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
  3635. during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
  3636. initialization, too.
  3637. @end deffn
  3638. The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
  3639. @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
  3640. Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
  3641. defaulting to the currently selected AP.
  3642. @end deffn
  3643. @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
  3644. Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
  3645. @end deffn
  3646. @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
  3647. @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
  3648. Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
  3649. or set a new value @var{value}.
  3650. @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
  3651. @end deffn
  3652. @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
  3653. Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
  3654. @end deffn
  3655. @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
  3656. Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
  3657. value @var{value}.
  3658. In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
  3659. @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
  3660. In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
  3661. @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
  3662. background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
  3663. @end deffn
  3664. @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
  3665. Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
  3666. defaulting to the currently selected AP.
  3667. @end deffn
  3668. @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
  3669. Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
  3670. memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
  3671. If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
  3672. @end deffn
  3673. @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
  3674. Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
  3675. At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
  3676. by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
  3677. and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
  3678. updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
  3679. the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
  3680. for details.
  3681. Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
  3682. The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
  3683. the pattern:
  3684. @example
  3685. kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
  3686. @end example
  3687. If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
  3688. where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
  3689. and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
  3690. DCache on Cortex-M7.
  3691. @example
  3692. set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
  3693. samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
  3694. @end example
  3695. Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
  3696. @example
  3697. set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
  3698. samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
  3699. @end example
  3700. @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
  3701. @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
  3702. @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
  3703. If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
  3704. example with a proper dap name:
  3705. @example
  3706. xxx.dap apcsw default
  3707. @end example
  3708. @end deffn
  3709. @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
  3710. Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
  3711. Disabled by default
  3712. @end deffn
  3713. @node CPU Configuration
  3714. @chapter CPU Configuration
  3715. @cindex GDB target
  3716. This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
  3717. You can also access these targets without GDB
  3718. (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
  3719. and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
  3720. through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
  3721. If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
  3722. We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
  3723. then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
  3724. @section Target List
  3725. @cindex target, current
  3726. @cindex target, list
  3727. All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
  3728. where each member has a name.
  3729. That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
  3730. You can display the list with the @command{targets}
  3731. (plural!) command.
  3732. This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
  3733. look like with more than one:
  3734. @verbatim
  3735. TargetName Type Endian TapName State
  3736. -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
  3737. 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
  3738. 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
  3739. @end verbatim
  3740. One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
  3741. is implicitly referenced by many commands.
  3742. It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
  3743. In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
  3744. space seen by that current target.
  3745. Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
  3746. and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
  3747. are examples; and there are many more.
  3748. Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
  3749. @deffn {Command} {target current}
  3750. Returns the name of the current target.
  3751. @end deffn
  3752. @deffn {Command} {target names}
  3753. Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
  3754. @example
  3755. foreach t [target names] @{
  3756. puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
  3757. @}
  3758. @end example
  3759. @end deffn
  3760. @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
  3761. @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
  3762. @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
  3763. @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
  3764. command names are singular.}
  3765. With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
  3766. targets in a user friendly form.
  3767. With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
  3768. the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
  3769. only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
  3770. @end deffn
  3771. @section Target CPU Types
  3772. @cindex target type
  3773. @cindex CPU type
  3774. Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
  3775. the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
  3776. when calling @command{target create}.
  3777. The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
  3778. It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
  3779. what kind of debug support it integrates,
  3780. whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
  3781. what core-specific commands may be available
  3782. (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
  3783. and more.
  3784. It's easy to see what target types are supported,
  3785. since there's a command to list them.
  3786. @anchor{targettypes}
  3787. @deffn {Command} {target types}
  3788. Lists all supported target types.
  3789. At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
  3790. @itemize @bullet
  3791. @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
  3792. @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
  3793. @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
  3794. @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
  3795. @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
  3796. @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
  3797. @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
  3798. @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
  3799. @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
  3800. @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
  3801. (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
  3802. @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
  3803. @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
  3804. @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
  3805. compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
  3806. @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
  3807. @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
  3808. @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
  3809. (Support for this is still incomplete.)
  3810. @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
  3811. @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
  3812. The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
  3813. @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
  3814. @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
  3815. @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
  3816. @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
  3817. allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
  3818. @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
  3819. a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
  3820. useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
  3821. support for new CPUs.
  3822. It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
  3823. specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
  3824. be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
  3825. @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
  3826. @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
  3827. @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
  3828. @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
  3829. @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
  3830. @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
  3831. The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
  3832. @itemize @minus
  3833. @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
  3834. @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
  3835. @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
  3836. @end itemize
  3837. And two debug interfaces cores:
  3838. @itemize @minus
  3839. @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
  3840. @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
  3841. @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
  3842. @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
  3843. @end itemize
  3844. @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
  3845. @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
  3846. @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
  3847. @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
  3848. @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
  3849. @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
  3850. not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
  3851. @end itemize
  3852. @end deffn
  3853. To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
  3854. this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
  3855. (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
  3856. The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
  3857. licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
  3858. Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
  3859. reflect design generations;
  3860. while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
  3861. reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
  3862. @anchor{targetconfiguration}
  3863. @section Target Configuration
  3864. Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
  3865. When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
  3866. which is used to set up the CPU support.
  3867. The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
  3868. right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
  3869. Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
  3870. use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
  3871. optional parts.
  3872. All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
  3873. command, created as part of target creation.
  3874. The two main things to configure after target creation are
  3875. a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
  3876. if the board setup code overrides them later;
  3877. and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
  3878. to be much more board-specific.
  3879. The key steps you use might look something like this
  3880. @example
  3881. dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
  3882. target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
  3883. MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
  3884. MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
  3885. MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
  3886. @end example
  3887. You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
  3888. on-chip SRAM.
  3889. Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
  3890. writes to target memory;
  3891. flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
  3892. GDB memory checksumming;
  3893. and more.
  3894. @quotation Warning
  3895. On more complex chips, the work area can become
  3896. inaccessible when application code
  3897. (such as an operating system)
  3898. enables or disables the MMU.
  3899. For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
  3900. address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
  3901. easy access to other addresses needed.
  3902. At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
  3903. @end quotation
  3904. It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
  3905. For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
  3906. common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
  3907. controllers.
  3908. That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
  3909. in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
  3910. external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
  3911. @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
  3912. This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
  3913. It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
  3914. command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
  3915. purposes including additional configuration.
  3916. @itemize @bullet
  3917. @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
  3918. By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
  3919. of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
  3920. using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
  3921. This name is also used to create the target object command,
  3922. referred to here as @command{$target_name},
  3923. and in other places the target needs to be identified.
  3924. @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
  3925. @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
  3926. @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
  3927. If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
  3928. You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
  3929. @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
  3930. @end itemize
  3931. @end deffn
  3932. @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
  3933. The options accepted by this command may also be
  3934. specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
  3935. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
  3936. using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
  3937. @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
  3938. For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
  3939. and changing its endianness.
  3940. @itemize @bullet
  3941. @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
  3942. used to access this target.
  3943. @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
  3944. this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
  3945. create and manage DAP instances.
  3946. @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
  3947. whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
  3948. @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
  3949. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  3950. Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
  3951. Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
  3952. two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
  3953. same event name assigns only one handler.
  3954. Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
  3955. before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
  3956. @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
  3957. whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
  3958. @emph{it is not backed up.}
  3959. When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
  3960. since performing a backup slows down operations.
  3961. For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
  3962. be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
  3963. @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
  3964. in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
  3965. or virtual address is being used.
  3966. @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
  3967. base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
  3968. @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
  3969. base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
  3970. @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
  3971. The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
  3972. @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
  3973. @anchor{rtostype}
  3974. @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
  3975. @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
  3976. @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
  3977. @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
  3978. @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
  3979. @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
  3980. @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
  3981. scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
  3982. access the target for debugging.
  3983. @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
  3984. @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
  3985. Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
  3986. to separate access ports of the same DAP.
  3987. @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
  3988. to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
  3989. where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
  3990. @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
  3991. for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
  3992. @anchor{gdbportoverride}
  3993. @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
  3994. possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
  3995. Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
  3996. command @command{gdb_port}.
  3997. @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
  3998. @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
  3999. number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
  4000. A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
  4001. See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
  4002. @end itemize
  4003. @end deffn
  4004. @section Other $target_name Commands
  4005. @cindex object command
  4006. The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
  4007. and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
  4008. A good Tk example is a on screen button.
  4009. Once a button is created a button
  4010. has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
  4011. class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
  4012. configure it like this:
  4013. @example
  4014. # Create
  4015. button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
  4016. # Modify
  4017. .foobar configure -foreground blue
  4018. # Query
  4019. set x [.foobar cget -background]
  4020. # Report
  4021. puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
  4022. @end example
  4023. In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
  4024. button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
  4025. @example
  4026. str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
  4027. omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
  4028. @end example
  4029. The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
  4030. @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
  4031. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
  4032. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
  4033. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
  4034. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
  4035. Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
  4036. use these to deal with specific reset cases.
  4037. They are not otherwise documented here.
  4038. @end deffn
  4039. @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
  4040. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
  4041. These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
  4042. The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
  4043. or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
  4044. In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
  4045. the target side uses raw memory.
  4046. The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
  4047. bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
  4048. The script orientation comes from working with data
  4049. values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
  4050. @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
  4051. and neither store nor return those values.
  4052. @itemize
  4053. @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
  4054. @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
  4055. @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
  4056. @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
  4057. @end itemize
  4058. @end deffn
  4059. @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
  4060. Each configuration parameter accepted by
  4061. @command{$target_name configure}
  4062. can be individually queried, to return its current value.
  4063. The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
  4064. accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
  4065. There are a few special cases:
  4066. @itemize @bullet
  4067. @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
  4068. event named @var{event_name}.
  4069. This is a special case because setting a handler requires
  4070. two parameters.
  4071. @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
  4072. This is a special case because this is set using
  4073. @command{target create} and can't be changed
  4074. using @command{$target_name configure}.
  4075. @end itemize
  4076. For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
  4077. all the targets you might use something like this:
  4078. @example
  4079. foreach name [target names] @{
  4080. set y [$name cget -endian]
  4081. set z [$name cget -type]
  4082. puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
  4083. $x $name $y $z]
  4084. @}
  4085. @end example
  4086. @end deffn
  4087. @anchor{targetcurstate}
  4088. @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
  4089. Displays the current target state:
  4090. @code{debug-running},
  4091. @code{halted},
  4092. @code{reset},
  4093. @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
  4094. (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
  4095. @end deffn
  4096. @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
  4097. Displays a table listing all event handlers
  4098. currently associated with this target.
  4099. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  4100. @end deffn
  4101. @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
  4102. Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
  4103. (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
  4104. code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
  4105. @end deffn
  4106. @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
  4107. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
  4108. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
  4109. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
  4110. Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
  4111. 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
  4112. 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
  4113. or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
  4114. When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
  4115. @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
  4116. Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
  4117. @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
  4118. If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
  4119. (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
  4120. see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
  4121. @end deffn
  4122. @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
  4123. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
  4124. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
  4125. @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
  4126. Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
  4127. @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
  4128. at the specified address @var{addr}.
  4129. When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
  4130. @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
  4131. Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
  4132. @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
  4133. If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
  4134. @end deffn
  4135. @anchor{targetevents}
  4136. @section Target Events
  4137. @cindex target events
  4138. @cindex events
  4139. At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
  4140. For example:
  4141. @itemize @bullet
  4142. @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
  4143. @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
  4144. @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
  4145. Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
  4146. SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
  4147. @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
  4148. to set up system clocks or
  4149. to reconfigure the SDRAM?
  4150. How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
  4151. to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
  4152. @end itemize
  4153. All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
  4154. These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
  4155. @command{target create ... -event}.
  4156. The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
  4157. buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
  4158. and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
  4159. @example
  4160. proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
  4161. echo "Disabling watchdog..."
  4162. mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
  4163. @}
  4164. mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
  4165. mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
  4166. echo "Disabling watchdog..."
  4167. mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
  4168. @}
  4169. @end example
  4170. The following target events are defined:
  4171. @itemize @bullet
  4172. @item @b{debug-halted}
  4173. @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
  4174. @item @b{debug-resumed}
  4175. @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
  4176. @item @b{early-halted}
  4177. @* Occurs early in the halt process
  4178. @item @b{examine-start}
  4179. @* Before target examine is called.
  4180. @item @b{examine-end}
  4181. @* After target examine is called with no errors.
  4182. @item @b{examine-fail}
  4183. @* After target examine fails.
  4184. @item @b{gdb-attach}
  4185. @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
  4186. starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
  4187. @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
  4188. connect GDB to running target.
  4189. The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
  4190. Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
  4191. @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
  4192. Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
  4193. hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
  4194. is in RAM or read only memory.
  4195. Default is @code{halt}
  4196. @item @b{gdb-detach}
  4197. @* When GDB disconnects
  4198. @item @b{gdb-end}
  4199. @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
  4200. @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
  4201. @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
  4202. @code{reset init})
  4203. @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
  4204. @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
  4205. @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
  4206. @* Before GDB writes to the flash
  4207. @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
  4208. @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
  4209. @item @b{gdb-start}
  4210. @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
  4211. @item @b{halted}
  4212. @* The target has halted
  4213. @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
  4214. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4215. after @command{reset-start} was triggered
  4216. but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
  4217. or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
  4218. @item @b{reset-assert}
  4219. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4220. after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
  4221. When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
  4222. it instead of asserting SRST.
  4223. This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
  4224. don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
  4225. selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
  4226. @item @b{reset-assert-post}
  4227. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4228. after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
  4229. or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
  4230. @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
  4231. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4232. after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
  4233. @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
  4234. @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
  4235. after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
  4236. and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
  4237. released on the scan chain.
  4238. @item @b{reset-end}
  4239. @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
  4240. @item @b{reset-init}
  4241. @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
  4242. This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
  4243. This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
  4244. you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
  4245. multiplexing, and so on.
  4246. (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
  4247. the target clocks are fully set up.)
  4248. @item @b{reset-start}
  4249. @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
  4250. before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
  4251. This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
  4252. or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
  4253. when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
  4254. @item @b{resume-start}
  4255. @* Before any target is resumed
  4256. @item @b{resume-end}
  4257. @* After all targets have resumed
  4258. @item @b{resumed}
  4259. @* Target has resumed
  4260. @item @b{step-start}
  4261. @* Before a target is single-stepped
  4262. @item @b{step-end}
  4263. @* After single-step has completed
  4264. @item @b{trace-config}
  4265. @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
  4266. @end itemize
  4267. @quotation Note
  4268. OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
  4269. is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
  4270. executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
  4271. @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
  4272. Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
  4273. disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
  4274. on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
  4275. a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
  4276. will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
  4277. check if the core has changed status.
  4278. @end quotation
  4279. @node Flash Commands
  4280. @chapter Flash Commands
  4281. OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
  4282. the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
  4283. the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
  4284. This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
  4285. NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
  4286. while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
  4287. used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
  4288. However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
  4289. for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
  4290. Flash Steps:
  4291. @enumerate
  4292. @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
  4293. @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
  4294. passing parameters as needed by the driver.
  4295. @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
  4296. @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
  4297. via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
  4298. boot loader, operating system, or other data.
  4299. @item GDB Flashing
  4300. @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
  4301. bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
  4302. @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
  4303. @end enumerate
  4304. Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
  4305. This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
  4306. so that it can't boot.
  4307. JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
  4308. board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
  4309. @anchor{norconfiguration}
  4310. @section Flash Configuration Commands
  4311. @cindex flash configuration
  4312. @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
  4313. Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
  4314. for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
  4315. These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
  4316. In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
  4317. see the driver-specific documentation.
  4318. @itemize @bullet
  4319. @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
  4320. in other flash commands. A number is also available.
  4321. @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
  4322. associated with the flash bank being declared.
  4323. This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
  4324. the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
  4325. @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
  4326. @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
  4327. @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
  4328. For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
  4329. @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
  4330. ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
  4331. @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
  4332. chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
  4333. @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
  4334. commands to the flash controller.
  4335. @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
  4336. @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
  4337. additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
  4338. for more information.
  4339. @end itemize
  4340. @quotation Note
  4341. This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
  4342. Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
  4343. @end quotation
  4344. @end deffn
  4345. @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
  4346. @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
  4347. Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
  4348. declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
  4349. Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
  4350. the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
  4351. @end deffn
  4352. @deffn {Command} {flash list}
  4353. Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
  4354. declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
  4355. This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
  4356. @end deffn
  4357. @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
  4358. Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
  4359. depends on the flash type.
  4360. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4361. Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
  4362. flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
  4363. but most don't bother.
  4364. @end deffn
  4365. @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
  4366. The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
  4367. begins.
  4368. @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
  4369. Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
  4370. until the programming session is finished.
  4371. If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
  4372. the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
  4373. The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
  4374. @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
  4375. @cindex flash erasing
  4376. @cindex flash reading
  4377. @cindex flash writing
  4378. @cindex flash programming
  4379. @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
  4380. One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
  4381. is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
  4382. This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
  4383. @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
  4384. @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
  4385. Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
  4386. before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
  4387. writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
  4388. for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
  4389. of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
  4390. @quotation Note
  4391. Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
  4392. chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
  4393. JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
  4394. back to a flash bank.
  4395. @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
  4396. @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
  4397. A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
  4398. and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
  4399. Avoid confusing the two command models.
  4400. @end quotation
  4401. Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
  4402. since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
  4403. For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
  4404. disabled first.
  4405. Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
  4406. and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
  4407. @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
  4408. @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
  4409. Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
  4410. up to and including @var{last}.
  4411. Sector numbering starts at 0.
  4412. Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
  4413. specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
  4414. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4415. @end deffn
  4416. @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
  4417. Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
  4418. Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
  4419. flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
  4420. Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
  4421. end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
  4422. The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
  4423. the specified length must stay within that bank.
  4424. As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
  4425. the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
  4426. If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
  4427. before erase starts.
  4428. @end deffn
  4429. @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
  4430. @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
  4431. @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
  4432. @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
  4433. Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
  4434. @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
  4435. starting at @var{address} and continuing
  4436. for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
  4437. No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
  4438. before issuing this command.
  4439. Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
  4440. verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
  4441. The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
  4442. each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
  4443. @end deffn
  4444. @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
  4445. @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
  4446. @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
  4447. @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
  4448. Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
  4449. 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
  4450. or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
  4451. If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
  4452. Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
  4453. from a bank not mapped in target address space.
  4454. The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
  4455. each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
  4456. @end deffn
  4457. @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
  4458. Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
  4459. starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
  4460. is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
  4461. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4462. @end deffn
  4463. @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
  4464. Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
  4465. and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
  4466. omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
  4467. read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
  4468. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4469. @end deffn
  4470. @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
  4471. Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
  4472. flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
  4473. start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
  4474. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4475. @end deffn
  4476. @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
  4477. Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
  4478. Only loadable sections from the image are written.
  4479. A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
  4480. to the base address for each section in the image.
  4481. The file [@var{type}] can be specified
  4482. explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
  4483. @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
  4484. @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
  4485. The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
  4486. if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
  4487. provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
  4488. program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
  4489. each image section.
  4490. @quotation Warning
  4491. Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
  4492. data you want to preserve.
  4493. Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
  4494. sections might be erased with no notice.
  4495. @itemize
  4496. @item
  4497. When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
  4498. sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
  4499. also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
  4500. @item
  4501. Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
  4502. For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
  4503. one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
  4504. erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
  4505. @end itemize
  4506. Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
  4507. it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
  4508. @end quotation
  4509. @end deffn
  4510. @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
  4511. Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
  4512. Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
  4513. In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
  4514. verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
  4515. memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
  4516. ordinary memory reads.
  4517. This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
  4518. addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
  4519. check for successful programming.
  4520. @end deffn
  4521. @section Other Flash commands
  4522. @cindex flash protection
  4523. @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
  4524. Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
  4525. and display that status.
  4526. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4527. @end deffn
  4528. @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
  4529. Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
  4530. and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
  4531. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4532. This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
  4533. and possibly stale information.
  4534. @end deffn
  4535. @anchor{flashprotect}
  4536. @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
  4537. Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
  4538. in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
  4539. and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
  4540. Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
  4541. specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
  4542. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  4543. The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
  4544. Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
  4545. See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
  4546. @end deffn
  4547. @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
  4548. Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
  4549. normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
  4550. command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
  4551. @end deffn
  4552. @anchor{program}
  4553. @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
  4554. This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
  4555. programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
  4556. @xref{Flash Programming}.
  4557. @end deffn
  4558. @anchor{flashdriverlist}
  4559. @section Flash Driver List
  4560. As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
  4561. and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
  4562. Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
  4563. @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
  4564. This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
  4565. address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
  4566. The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
  4567. @itemize
  4568. @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
  4569. @end itemize
  4570. So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
  4571. the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
  4572. the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
  4573. @example
  4574. flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4575. flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
  4576. $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
  4577. flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
  4578. $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
  4579. @end example
  4580. @end deffn
  4581. @subsection External Flash
  4582. @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
  4583. @cindex Common Flash Interface
  4584. @cindex CFI
  4585. The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
  4586. external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
  4587. specific external chip select on the CPU.
  4588. Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
  4589. Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
  4590. configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
  4591. configure a bus and its timings), or
  4592. perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
  4593. on the flash chip.
  4594. The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
  4595. speed up operation.
  4596. The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
  4597. @itemize
  4598. @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
  4599. like AM29LV010 and similar types.
  4600. @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
  4601. @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
  4602. @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
  4603. swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
  4604. @end itemize
  4605. To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
  4606. wide on a sixteen bit bus:
  4607. @example
  4608. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
  4609. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
  4610. @end example
  4611. To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
  4612. built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
  4613. to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
  4614. @example
  4615. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
  4616. @end example
  4617. @c "cfi part_id" disabled
  4618. @end deffn
  4619. @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
  4620. @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
  4621. @cindex SPI
  4622. @cindex jtagspi
  4623. @cindex bscan_spi
  4624. Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
  4625. SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
  4626. is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
  4627. exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
  4628. accessed through JTAG.
  4629. Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
  4630. a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
  4631. the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
  4632. a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
  4633. @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
  4634. @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
  4635. This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
  4636. tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
  4637. "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
  4638. mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
  4639. will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
  4640. @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
  4641. functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
  4642. @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
  4643. @itemize
  4644. @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
  4645. For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
  4646. @var{USER1} instruction.
  4647. @end itemize
  4648. @example
  4649. target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
  4650. set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
  4651. flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
  4652. $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
  4653. @end example
  4654. @end deffn
  4655. @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
  4656. @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
  4657. @cindex xcf
  4658. Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
  4659. It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
  4660. only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
  4661. They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
  4662. additional @var{xcf} driver command:
  4663. @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
  4664. command accepts additional parameters:
  4665. @itemize
  4666. @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
  4667. @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
  4668. @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
  4669. @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
  4670. in master mode.
  4671. @end itemize
  4672. @example
  4673. xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
  4674. @end example
  4675. All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
  4676. in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
  4677. CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
  4678. every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
  4679. dedicated sector.
  4680. @end deffn
  4681. @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
  4682. Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
  4683. button.
  4684. @example
  4685. xcf configure 0
  4686. @end example
  4687. @end deffn
  4688. Additional driver notes:
  4689. @itemize
  4690. @item Only single revision supported.
  4691. @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
  4692. only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
  4693. (Intel hex) file types supported.
  4694. @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
  4695. @end itemize
  4696. @end deffn
  4697. @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
  4698. @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
  4699. @cindex SPIFI
  4700. @cindex lpcspifi
  4701. NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
  4702. Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
  4703. memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
  4704. The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
  4705. program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
  4706. Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
  4707. to be configured on the target device; more than this will
  4708. significantly reduce flash programming times.
  4709. The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
  4710. other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
  4711. are configured by the driver.
  4712. @example
  4713. flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4714. @end example
  4715. @end deffn
  4716. @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
  4717. @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
  4718. @cindex SMI
  4719. @cindex stmsmi
  4720. Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
  4721. SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
  4722. ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
  4723. SPI flash devices.
  4724. Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
  4725. flash devices can be connected.
  4726. SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
  4727. space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
  4728. CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
  4729. Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
  4730. the flash content.
  4731. The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
  4732. to identify the memory bank.
  4733. All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
  4734. flash size, are detected automatically.
  4735. @example
  4736. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4737. @end example
  4738. @end deffn
  4739. @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
  4740. @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
  4741. @cindex QuadSPI
  4742. @cindex OctoSPI
  4743. @cindex stmqspi
  4744. Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
  4745. (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
  4746. controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
  4747. The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
  4748. Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
  4749. mode is not.
  4750. QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
  4751. space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
  4752. mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
  4753. CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
  4754. The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
  4755. parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
  4756. by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
  4757. The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
  4758. for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
  4759. list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
  4760. board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
  4761. flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
  4762. 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
  4763. Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
  4764. but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
  4765. due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
  4766. should be avoided.
  4767. It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
  4768. bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
  4769. due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
  4770. and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
  4771. change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
  4772. both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
  4773. Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
  4774. driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
  4775. The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
  4776. openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
  4777. persist across openocd invocations.
  4778. OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
  4779. these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
  4780. is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
  4781. required (see 'set' command).
  4782. @example
  4783. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
  4784. $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
  4785. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
  4786. $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
  4787. @end example
  4788. There are three specific commands
  4789. @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
  4790. Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
  4791. chip specific write protection engaged.
  4792. @end deffn
  4793. @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
  4794. Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
  4795. in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
  4796. are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
  4797. @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
  4798. and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
  4799. This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
  4800. which don't support an id command.
  4801. In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
  4802. a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
  4803. @end deffn
  4804. @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
  4805. If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
  4806. bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
  4807. sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
  4808. i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
  4809. If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
  4810. sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
  4811. are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
  4812. @var{resp_num} must be even.
  4813. Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
  4814. To check basic communication settings, issue
  4815. @example
  4816. stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
  4817. stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
  4818. @end example
  4819. for single flash mode or
  4820. @example
  4821. stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
  4822. stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
  4823. @end example
  4824. for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
  4825. In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
  4826. complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
  4827. need a dummy address, e.g.
  4828. @example
  4829. stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
  4830. @end example
  4831. should return the status register contents.
  4832. @end deffn
  4833. @end deffn
  4834. @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
  4835. This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
  4836. Microcontroller platform.
  4837. The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
  4838. hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
  4839. @example
  4840. flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
  4841. @end example
  4842. @end deffn
  4843. @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
  4844. @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
  4845. @cindex ath79
  4846. Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
  4847. chip selects.
  4848. On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
  4849. directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
  4850. and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
  4851. Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
  4852. the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
  4853. 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
  4854. The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
  4855. to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
  4856. is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
  4857. to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
  4858. address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
  4859. chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
  4860. that does not overlap with real memory regions.
  4861. Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
  4862. An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
  4863. with the default CS0.
  4864. CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
  4865. since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
  4866. CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
  4867. @example
  4868. flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4869. # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
  4870. # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
  4871. # distinguish the banks.
  4872. flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
  4873. flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
  4874. flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
  4875. @end example
  4876. @end deffn
  4877. @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
  4878. @cindex Freedom E SPI
  4879. @cindex fespi
  4880. SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
  4881. @example
  4882. flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4883. @end example
  4884. @end deffn
  4885. @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
  4886. @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
  4887. The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
  4888. include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
  4889. The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
  4890. The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
  4891. since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
  4892. @example
  4893. flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4894. @end example
  4895. @end deffn
  4896. @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
  4897. @cindex ambiqmicro
  4898. @cindex apollo
  4899. All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
  4900. Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
  4901. The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
  4902. with the target using SWD.
  4903. The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
  4904. the device class of the MCU.
  4905. The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
  4906. to set up the flash banks.
  4907. If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
  4908. sizes of an Apollo chip.
  4909. All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
  4910. In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
  4911. and the second bank starts after the first.
  4912. @example
  4913. # Flash bank 0
  4914. flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  4915. # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
  4916. flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
  4917. $_TARGETNAME
  4918. @end example
  4919. Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
  4920. This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
  4921. are available to the user.
  4922. The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
  4923. @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
  4924. Erase entire bank.
  4925. @end deffn
  4926. @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
  4927. Erase device pages.
  4928. @end deffn
  4929. @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
  4930. Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
  4931. The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
  4932. Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
  4933. the flash.
  4934. @end deffn
  4935. @end deffn
  4936. @anchor{at91samd}
  4937. @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
  4938. @cindex at91samd
  4939. All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
  4940. families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
  4941. Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
  4942. The devices have one flash bank:
  4943. @example
  4944. flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
  4945. @end example
  4946. @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
  4947. Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
  4948. used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
  4949. processor to be halted.
  4950. @end deffn
  4951. @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
  4952. Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
  4953. to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
  4954. erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
  4955. time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
  4956. therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
  4957. @example
  4958. at91samd set-security enable
  4959. @end example
  4960. @end deffn
  4961. @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
  4962. Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
  4963. of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
  4964. must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
  4965. written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
  4966. requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
  4967. the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
  4968. in order to disable this feature.
  4969. @example
  4970. at91samd eeprom
  4971. at91samd eeprom 1024
  4972. @end example
  4973. @end deffn
  4974. @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
  4975. Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
  4976. Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
  4977. must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
  4978. to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
  4979. MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
  4980. @example
  4981. at91samd bootloader
  4982. at91samd bootloader 16384
  4983. @end example
  4984. @end deffn
  4985. @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
  4986. This command releases internal reset held by DSU
  4987. and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
  4988. Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
  4989. @end deffn
  4990. @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
  4991. Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
  4992. 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
  4993. data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
  4994. arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
  4995. is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
  4996. Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
  4997. reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
  4998. @example
  4999. # Read user row
  5000. >at91samd nvmuserrow
  5001. NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
  5002. # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
  5003. >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
  5004. # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
  5005. # byte unchanged
  5006. >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
  5007. @end example
  5008. @end deffn
  5009. @end deffn
  5010. @anchor{at91sam3}
  5011. @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
  5012. @cindex at91sam3
  5013. All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
  5014. Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
  5015. currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
  5016. that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
  5017. AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
  5018. the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
  5019. readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
  5020. chips are confirmed.}
  5021. The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
  5022. have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
  5023. the following fixed locations:
  5024. @example
  5025. # Flash bank 0 - all chips
  5026. flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
  5027. # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
  5028. flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
  5029. @end example
  5030. Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
  5031. Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
  5032. to the @command{flash bank} command:
  5033. @itemize
  5034. @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
  5035. @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
  5036. @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
  5037. @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
  5038. @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
  5039. @end itemize
  5040. The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
  5041. @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
  5042. @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
  5043. @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
  5044. @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
  5045. With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
  5046. shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
  5047. With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
  5048. With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
  5049. modifies that GPNVM bit.
  5050. @end deffn
  5051. @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
  5052. This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
  5053. chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
  5054. Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
  5055. document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
  5056. various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
  5057. believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
  5058. be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
  5059. @end deffn
  5060. @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
  5061. This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
  5062. @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
  5063. @end deffn
  5064. @end deffn
  5065. @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
  5066. @cindex at91sam4
  5067. All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
  5068. Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
  5069. This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
  5070. @end deffn
  5071. @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
  5072. @cindex at91sam4l
  5073. All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
  5074. Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
  5075. This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
  5076. The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
  5077. @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
  5078. This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
  5079. and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
  5080. Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
  5081. @end deffn
  5082. @end deffn
  5083. @anchor{atsame5}
  5084. @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
  5085. @cindex atsame5
  5086. All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
  5087. families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
  5088. and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
  5089. The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
  5090. This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
  5091. Bank swapping is not supported yet.
  5092. @example
  5093. flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
  5094. @end example
  5095. @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
  5096. Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
  5097. Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
  5098. must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
  5099. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
  5100. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
  5101. @example
  5102. atsame5 bootloader
  5103. atsame5 bootloader 16384
  5104. @end example
  5105. @end deffn
  5106. @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
  5107. Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
  5108. used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
  5109. processor to be halted.
  5110. @end deffn
  5111. @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
  5112. This command releases internal reset held by DSU
  5113. and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
  5114. Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
  5115. @end deffn
  5116. @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
  5117. Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
  5118. 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
  5119. Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
  5120. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
  5121. is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
  5122. (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
  5123. The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
  5124. @example
  5125. # Read
  5126. >atsame5 userpage
  5127. USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
  5128. # Write
  5129. >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
  5130. # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
  5131. # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
  5132. # bytes)
  5133. >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
  5134. @end example
  5135. @end deffn
  5136. @end deffn
  5137. @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
  5138. @cindex atsamv
  5139. All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
  5140. Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
  5141. This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
  5142. @end deffn
  5143. @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
  5144. All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
  5145. internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
  5146. recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
  5147. register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5148. @example
  5149. flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5150. @end example
  5151. For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
  5152. provide additional parameters in the following order:
  5153. @itemize
  5154. @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
  5155. @item @var{banks}
  5156. @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
  5157. @item @var{pages_per_sector}
  5158. @item @var{pages_size}
  5159. @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
  5160. @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
  5161. optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
  5162. @end itemize
  5163. It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
  5164. except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
  5165. will be autoconfigured.
  5166. Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
  5167. The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
  5168. basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
  5169. However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
  5170. plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
  5171. @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
  5172. @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
  5173. Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
  5174. bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
  5175. used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
  5176. are not truly general purpose).
  5177. @quotation Note
  5178. This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
  5179. the appropriate at91sam7 target.
  5180. @end quotation
  5181. @end deffn
  5182. @end deffn
  5183. @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
  5184. The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
  5185. @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
  5186. @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
  5187. @end deffn
  5188. @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
  5189. STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
  5190. The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
  5191. the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
  5192. @example
  5193. flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5194. @end example
  5195. Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
  5196. each single sector one by one.
  5197. @example
  5198. flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
  5199. @end example
  5200. Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
  5201. @end deffn
  5202. @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
  5203. All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
  5204. Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
  5205. CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
  5206. specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
  5207. starts at address 0.
  5208. @example
  5209. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5210. @end example
  5211. @end deffn
  5212. @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
  5213. The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
  5214. Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
  5215. supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
  5216. programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
  5217. the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
  5218. documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
  5219. and programming the serial flash.
  5220. @example
  5221. flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5222. @end example
  5223. @end deffn
  5224. @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
  5225. All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
  5226. internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
  5227. a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
  5228. autoconfigures itself.
  5229. @example
  5230. flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5231. @end example
  5232. A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
  5233. debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
  5234. this via the following command:
  5235. @example
  5236. efm32 debuglock num
  5237. @end example
  5238. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5239. Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
  5240. @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
  5241. supported.}
  5242. @end deffn
  5243. @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
  5244. Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
  5245. via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
  5246. configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
  5247. configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
  5248. frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
  5249. @example
  5250. flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
  5251. $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
  5252. @end example
  5253. @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
  5254. Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
  5255. @end deffn
  5256. @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
  5257. Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
  5258. is an uncommon operation.}
  5259. @end deffn
  5260. @end deffn
  5261. @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
  5262. All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
  5263. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
  5264. The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
  5265. correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
  5266. @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
  5267. @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
  5268. @example
  5269. flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5270. @end example
  5271. @end deffn
  5272. @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
  5273. All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
  5274. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
  5275. The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
  5276. correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
  5277. @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
  5278. @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
  5279. with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
  5280. characters) ignored.
  5281. @example
  5282. flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
  5283. $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
  5284. flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
  5285. $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
  5286. @end example
  5287. @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
  5288. nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
  5289. @end deffn
  5290. @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
  5291. @cindex kinetis
  5292. Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
  5293. from NXP (former Freescale) include
  5294. internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
  5295. recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
  5296. identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5297. Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
  5298. The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
  5299. @itemize
  5300. @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
  5301. @end itemize
  5302. @example
  5303. flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5304. @end example
  5305. @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
  5306. Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
  5307. based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
  5308. Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
  5309. @end deffn
  5310. @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
  5311. Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
  5312. @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
  5313. set by 'flash protect' command.
  5314. This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
  5315. writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
  5316. @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
  5317. Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
  5318. with the rest of a flash image.
  5319. @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
  5320. @end deffn
  5321. @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
  5322. Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
  5323. Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
  5324. @end deffn
  5325. @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
  5326. Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
  5327. and examine-fail event.
  5328. @end deffn
  5329. @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
  5330. Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
  5331. loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
  5332. @end deffn
  5333. @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
  5334. Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
  5335. back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
  5336. to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
  5337. command completes.
  5338. @end deffn
  5339. @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
  5340. For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
  5341. Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
  5342. sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
  5343. of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
  5344. For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
  5345. Program Partition command.
  5346. Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
  5347. Reset the device after partition setting.
  5348. Show partition size:
  5349. @example
  5350. kinetis nvm_partition info
  5351. @end example
  5352. Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
  5353. of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
  5354. @example
  5355. kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
  5356. @end example
  5357. Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
  5358. of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
  5359. @example
  5360. kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
  5361. @end example
  5362. @end deffn
  5363. @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
  5364. Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
  5365. RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
  5366. @end deffn
  5367. @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
  5368. For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
  5369. Command disables watchdog timer.
  5370. @end deffn
  5371. @end deffn
  5372. @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
  5373. @cindex kinetis_ke
  5374. KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
  5375. internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
  5376. the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
  5377. autoconfigures itself.
  5378. Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
  5379. @example
  5380. flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5381. @end example
  5382. @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
  5383. Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
  5384. @end deffn
  5385. @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
  5386. Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
  5387. This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
  5388. Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
  5389. It does not require the processor to be halted.
  5390. @end deffn
  5391. @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
  5392. Command disables watchdog timer.
  5393. @end deffn
  5394. @end deffn
  5395. @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
  5396. This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
  5397. LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
  5398. the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
  5399. LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
  5400. @quotation Note
  5401. There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
  5402. driver:
  5403. The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
  5404. The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
  5405. @end quotation
  5406. The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
  5407. which must appear in the following order:
  5408. @itemize
  5409. @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
  5410. @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
  5411. @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
  5412. @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
  5413. @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
  5414. LPC43x[2357])
  5415. @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
  5416. @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
  5417. @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
  5418. @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
  5419. @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
  5420. or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
  5421. LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
  5422. @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
  5423. at which the core is running
  5424. @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
  5425. telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
  5426. @quotation Note
  5427. If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
  5428. table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
  5429. However, if you do provide it,
  5430. with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
  5431. @end quotation
  5432. @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
  5433. ROM IAP entry point.
  5434. @end itemize
  5435. LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  5436. @example
  5437. flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
  5438. lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
  5439. @end example
  5440. @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
  5441. Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
  5442. the specified flash @var{bank}.
  5443. @end deffn
  5444. @end deffn
  5445. @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
  5446. The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
  5447. support from its lpc2000 siblings.
  5448. The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
  5449. the programming clock rate in Hz.
  5450. LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  5451. @example
  5452. flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
  5453. @end example
  5454. @end deffn
  5455. @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
  5456. This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
  5457. from NXP.
  5458. The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
  5459. @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
  5460. sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
  5461. The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
  5462. (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
  5463. will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
  5464. @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
  5465. you start the PLL.
  5466. The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
  5467. The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
  5468. It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
  5469. handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
  5470. Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
  5471. sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
  5472. What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
  5473. actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
  5474. sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
  5475. mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
  5476. and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
  5477. Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
  5478. @example
  5479. flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
  5480. @end example
  5481. Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
  5482. the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
  5483. @code{flash banks} command.
  5484. @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
  5485. Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
  5486. content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
  5487. very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
  5488. a known signature.
  5489. Example:
  5490. @example
  5491. lpc2900 signature 0
  5492. signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
  5493. @end example
  5494. @end deffn
  5495. @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
  5496. Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
  5497. saves it to a file in binary format.
  5498. Example:
  5499. @example
  5500. lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
  5501. @end example
  5502. @end deffn
  5503. The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
  5504. erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
  5505. commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
  5506. command:
  5507. @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
  5508. You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
  5509. @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
  5510. @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
  5511. The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
  5512. Example:
  5513. @example
  5514. lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
  5515. Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
  5516. @end example
  5517. @end deffn
  5518. @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
  5519. Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
  5520. sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
  5521. for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
  5522. @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
  5523. contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
  5524. 912 bytes.
  5525. @quotation Attention
  5526. This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
  5527. @end quotation
  5528. Example:
  5529. @example
  5530. lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
  5531. @end example
  5532. @end deffn
  5533. @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
  5534. Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
  5535. further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
  5536. after the next power cycle.
  5537. @quotation Attention
  5538. This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
  5539. @end quotation
  5540. Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
  5541. Example:
  5542. @example
  5543. lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
  5544. flash info 0
  5545. #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
  5546. # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
  5547. # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
  5548. # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
  5549. @end example
  5550. @end deffn
  5551. @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
  5552. Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
  5553. effective after the next power cycle.
  5554. @quotation Attention
  5555. This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
  5556. @end quotation
  5557. Examples:
  5558. @example
  5559. lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
  5560. @end example
  5561. @end deffn
  5562. @end deffn
  5563. @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
  5564. This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
  5565. based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
  5566. read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
  5567. @example
  5568. flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
  5569. 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
  5570. @end example
  5571. @itemize @bullet
  5572. @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
  5573. @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
  5574. @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
  5575. @end itemize
  5576. Example usage:
  5577. @example
  5578. if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
  5579. flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
  5580. 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
  5581. @} else @{
  5582. flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
  5583. 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
  5584. @}
  5585. @end example
  5586. @end deffn
  5587. @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
  5588. All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
  5589. Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
  5590. recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
  5591. Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
  5592. MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
  5593. @example
  5594. flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5595. @end example
  5596. @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
  5597. Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
  5598. only the main program flash.
  5599. On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
  5600. main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
  5601. flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
  5602. @end deffn
  5603. @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
  5604. On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
  5605. region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
  5606. Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
  5607. To erase and program the BSL:
  5608. @example
  5609. msp432 bsl unlock
  5610. flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
  5611. flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
  5612. msp432 bsl lock
  5613. @end example
  5614. @end deffn
  5615. @end deffn
  5616. @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
  5617. This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
  5618. based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
  5619. Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
  5620. Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
  5621. but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
  5622. Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
  5623. There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
  5624. also have division into regions: main and info.
  5625. Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
  5626. Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
  5627. @example
  5628. flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5629. @end example
  5630. Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
  5631. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
  5632. Read byte from main or info userflash region.
  5633. @end deffn
  5634. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
  5635. Write byte to main or info userflash region.
  5636. @end deffn
  5637. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
  5638. Erase all userflash including info region.
  5639. @end deffn
  5640. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
  5641. Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
  5642. @end deffn
  5643. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
  5644. Check sectors protect.
  5645. @end deffn
  5646. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
  5647. Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
  5648. @end deffn
  5649. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
  5650. Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
  5651. @end deffn
  5652. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
  5653. Configure external memory interface for boot.
  5654. @end deffn
  5655. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
  5656. Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
  5657. @end deffn
  5658. @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
  5659. Show information about flash driver.
  5660. @end deffn
  5661. @end deffn
  5662. @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
  5663. All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
  5664. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
  5665. Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
  5666. internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
  5667. @example
  5668. flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5669. @end example
  5670. Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
  5671. @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
  5672. Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
  5673. configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
  5674. works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
  5675. code.
  5676. @end deffn
  5677. @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
  5678. Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
  5679. @end deffn
  5680. @end deffn
  5681. @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
  5682. This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
  5683. protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
  5684. It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
  5685. over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
  5686. loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
  5687. available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
  5688. @example
  5689. flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5690. @end example
  5691. @end deffn
  5692. @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
  5693. The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
  5694. and integrate flash memory.
  5695. @example
  5696. flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5697. flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5698. @end example
  5699. @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
  5700. @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
  5701. @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
  5702. @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
  5703. Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
  5704. @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
  5705. Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
  5706. in the specified chip @var{bank}.
  5707. @end deffn
  5708. @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
  5709. Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
  5710. This will remove any Code Protection.
  5711. @end deffn
  5712. @end deffn
  5713. @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
  5714. All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
  5715. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
  5716. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  5717. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5718. Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
  5719. System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
  5720. @example
  5721. flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5722. @end example
  5723. psoc4-specific commands
  5724. @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
  5725. Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
  5726. If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
  5727. Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
  5728. If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
  5729. system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
  5730. This mode is suitable for gdb load.
  5731. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5732. @end deffn
  5733. @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
  5734. Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
  5735. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5736. @end deffn
  5737. @end deffn
  5738. @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
  5739. All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
  5740. include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
  5741. The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
  5742. apart from the base address.
  5743. @example
  5744. flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5745. @end example
  5746. @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
  5747. @quotation Attention
  5748. If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
  5749. the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
  5750. then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
  5751. Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
  5752. @end quotation
  5753. Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
  5754. @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
  5755. Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
  5756. and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
  5757. @end deffn
  5758. @end deffn
  5759. @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
  5760. All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
  5761. include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
  5762. The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
  5763. apart from the base address.
  5764. @example
  5765. flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
  5766. $_TARGETNAME
  5767. @end example
  5768. @end deffn
  5769. @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
  5770. All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
  5771. include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
  5772. The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
  5773. @example
  5774. flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5775. @end example
  5776. PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
  5777. @itemize
  5778. @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
  5779. @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
  5780. @end itemize
  5781. @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
  5782. The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
  5783. @quotation Attention
  5784. Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
  5785. after successful write.
  5786. @end quotation
  5787. @end deffn
  5788. @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
  5789. Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
  5790. PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
  5791. the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
  5792. Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
  5793. @itemize @bullet
  5794. @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
  5795. Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
  5796. 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
  5797. @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
  5798. (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
  5799. row size: 512 bytes.
  5800. @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
  5801. service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
  5802. be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
  5803. operation will erase row automatically.
  5804. @end itemize
  5805. All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
  5806. automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
  5807. PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
  5808. @example
  5809. flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
  5810. $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5811. flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
  5812. $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5813. flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
  5814. $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5815. flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
  5816. $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5817. flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
  5818. $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5819. flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
  5820. $@{TARGET@}.cm0
  5821. flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
  5822. $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5823. flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
  5824. $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5825. flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
  5826. $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5827. flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
  5828. $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5829. flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
  5830. $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5831. flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
  5832. $@{TARGET@}.cm4
  5833. @end example
  5834. psoc6-specific commands
  5835. @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
  5836. Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
  5837. When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
  5838. and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
  5839. reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
  5840. instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
  5841. @end deffn
  5842. @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
  5843. Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
  5844. by @command{flash banks}.
  5845. Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
  5846. @end deffn
  5847. @end deffn
  5848. @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
  5849. Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
  5850. RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
  5851. Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
  5852. external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
  5853. @example
  5854. flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
  5855. @end example
  5856. @end deffn
  5857. @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
  5858. All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
  5859. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
  5860. and SWD interface.
  5861. The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
  5862. If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
  5863. @example
  5864. flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5865. @end example
  5866. There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
  5867. @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
  5868. Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
  5869. And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
  5870. @end deffn
  5871. @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
  5872. Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
  5873. @end deffn
  5874. @end deffn
  5875. @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
  5876. All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
  5877. families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
  5878. automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
  5879. identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5880. @example
  5881. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5882. @end example
  5883. @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
  5884. Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
  5885. the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
  5886. default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
  5887. protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
  5888. disabled.
  5889. Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
  5890. must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
  5891. @quotation Warning
  5892. if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
  5893. applied to all of them.
  5894. @end quotation
  5895. @end deffn
  5896. @end deffn
  5897. @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
  5898. All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
  5899. from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0 and GD32F3x0 microcontroller
  5900. families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
  5901. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  5902. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5903. @example
  5904. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5905. @end example
  5906. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  5907. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  5908. the flash driver.
  5909. @example
  5910. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5911. @end example
  5912. If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
  5913. as per the following example.
  5914. @example
  5915. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5916. @end example
  5917. Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
  5918. @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
  5919. Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
  5920. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5921. @end deffn
  5922. @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
  5923. Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
  5924. a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
  5925. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5926. @end deffn
  5927. @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
  5928. Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
  5929. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5930. @end deffn
  5931. @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
  5932. Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
  5933. or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
  5934. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5935. @end deffn
  5936. @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
  5937. Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
  5938. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5939. The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
  5940. @end deffn
  5941. @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
  5942. Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
  5943. by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
  5944. without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
  5945. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5946. @end deffn
  5947. @end deffn
  5948. @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
  5949. All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
  5950. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
  5951. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  5952. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  5953. @example
  5954. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5955. @end example
  5956. If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
  5957. as per the following example.
  5958. @example
  5959. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5960. @end example
  5961. @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
  5962. Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
  5963. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5964. @end deffn
  5965. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  5966. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  5967. the flash driver.
  5968. @example
  5969. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  5970. @end example
  5971. Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
  5972. @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
  5973. Locks the entire stm32 device.
  5974. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5975. @end deffn
  5976. @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
  5977. Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
  5978. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5979. @end deffn
  5980. @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
  5981. Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
  5982. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5983. @end deffn
  5984. @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
  5985. Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
  5986. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  5987. @end deffn
  5988. @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
  5989. Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
  5990. Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
  5991. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
  5992. 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
  5993. @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
  5994. @end deffn
  5995. @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
  5996. Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
  5997. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
  5998. @end deffn
  5999. @end deffn
  6000. @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
  6001. All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
  6002. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
  6003. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  6004. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  6005. @example
  6006. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  6007. @end example
  6008. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  6009. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  6010. the flash driver.
  6011. @example
  6012. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  6013. @end example
  6014. Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
  6015. @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
  6016. Locks the entire stm32 device.
  6017. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6018. @end deffn
  6019. @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
  6020. Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
  6021. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6022. @end deffn
  6023. @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
  6024. Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
  6025. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6026. @end deffn
  6027. @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
  6028. Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
  6029. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
  6030. is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
  6031. For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
  6032. Example usage:
  6033. @example
  6034. # read OPTSR_CUR
  6035. stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
  6036. # read WPSN_CUR1R
  6037. stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
  6038. # read WPSN_CUR2R
  6039. stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
  6040. @end example
  6041. @end deffn
  6042. @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
  6043. Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
  6044. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
  6045. is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
  6046. and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
  6047. will be touched).
  6048. Example usage:
  6049. @example
  6050. # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
  6051. # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
  6052. stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
  6053. @end example
  6054. @end deffn
  6055. @end deffn
  6056. @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
  6057. All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
  6058. include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
  6059. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  6060. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  6061. @example
  6062. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  6063. @end example
  6064. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  6065. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  6066. the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
  6067. driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
  6068. second bank.
  6069. @example
  6070. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  6071. @end example
  6072. Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
  6073. @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
  6074. Locks the entire stm32 device.
  6075. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6076. @end deffn
  6077. @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
  6078. Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
  6079. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6080. @end deffn
  6081. @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
  6082. Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
  6083. data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
  6084. Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
  6085. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6086. @end deffn
  6087. @end deffn
  6088. @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
  6089. All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
  6090. microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
  6091. and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
  6092. The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
  6093. the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
  6094. @example
  6095. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  6096. @end example
  6097. If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
  6098. as per the following example.
  6099. @example
  6100. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  6101. @end example
  6102. @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
  6103. Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
  6104. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6105. @end deffn
  6106. Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
  6107. an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
  6108. the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
  6109. wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
  6110. @example
  6111. flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  6112. @end example
  6113. Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
  6114. @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
  6115. Locks the entire stm32 device.
  6116. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6117. @end deffn
  6118. @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
  6119. Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
  6120. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6121. @end deffn
  6122. @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
  6123. Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
  6124. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6125. @end deffn
  6126. @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
  6127. Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
  6128. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
  6129. is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
  6130. For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
  6131. @example
  6132. stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
  6133. # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
  6134. # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
  6135. # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
  6136. @end example
  6137. The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
  6138. option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
  6139. @end deffn
  6140. @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
  6141. Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
  6142. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
  6143. is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
  6144. to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
  6145. For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
  6146. @example
  6147. stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
  6148. @end example
  6149. The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
  6150. Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
  6151. This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
  6152. @end deffn
  6153. @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
  6154. List the protected areas using WRP.
  6155. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6156. @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
  6157. if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
  6158. @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
  6159. Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
  6160. in single or dual-banks mode.
  6161. Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
  6162. write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
  6163. @end deffn
  6164. @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
  6165. Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
  6166. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6167. @end deffn
  6168. @end deffn
  6169. @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
  6170. All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
  6171. include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
  6172. The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
  6173. which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
  6174. @example
  6175. flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
  6176. 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
  6177. @end example
  6178. @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
  6179. Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
  6180. for the specified flash bank.
  6181. @end deffn
  6182. @end deffn
  6183. @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
  6184. Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
  6185. include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
  6186. The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
  6187. the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
  6188. @example
  6189. flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  6190. str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
  6191. @end example
  6192. @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
  6193. Configures the str9 flash controller.
  6194. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
  6195. @itemize @bullet
  6196. @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
  6197. @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
  6198. @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
  6199. @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
  6200. @end itemize
  6201. @end deffn
  6202. @end deffn
  6203. @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
  6204. @cindex str9xpec
  6205. Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
  6206. Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
  6207. Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
  6208. @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
  6209. Here is some background info to help
  6210. you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
  6211. the str9:
  6212. @enumerate
  6213. @item
  6214. Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
  6215. flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
  6216. @item
  6217. Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
  6218. ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
  6219. core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
  6220. for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
  6221. @end enumerate
  6222. Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
  6223. the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
  6224. configured for flash bank 0.
  6225. @example
  6226. # assert srst, we do not want core running
  6227. # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
  6228. adapter assert srst
  6229. # turn off target polling
  6230. poll off
  6231. # disable str9 core
  6232. str9xpec enable_turbo 0
  6233. # read option bytes
  6234. str9xpec options_read 0
  6235. # re-enable str9 core
  6236. str9xpec disable_turbo 0
  6237. poll on
  6238. reset halt
  6239. @end example
  6240. The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
  6241. When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
  6242. has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
  6243. as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
  6244. Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
  6245. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
  6246. Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
  6247. @end deffn
  6248. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
  6249. Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
  6250. directly to the embedded flash controller.
  6251. @end deffn
  6252. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
  6253. Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
  6254. erase the device.
  6255. @end deffn
  6256. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
  6257. Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
  6258. @end deffn
  6259. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
  6260. Configure str9 boot bank.
  6261. @end deffn
  6262. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
  6263. Configure str9 lvd source.
  6264. @end deffn
  6265. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
  6266. Configure str9 lvd threshold.
  6267. @end deffn
  6268. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
  6269. Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
  6270. @end deffn
  6271. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
  6272. Read str9 option bytes.
  6273. @end deffn
  6274. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
  6275. Write str9 option bytes.
  6276. @end deffn
  6277. @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
  6278. unlock str9 device.
  6279. @end deffn
  6280. @end deffn
  6281. @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
  6282. @cindex swm050
  6283. All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
  6284. @example
  6285. flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
  6286. @end example
  6287. One swm050-specific command is defined:
  6288. @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
  6289. Erases the entire flash bank.
  6290. @end deffn
  6291. @end deffn
  6292. @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
  6293. Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
  6294. include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
  6295. This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  6296. Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
  6297. @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
  6298. Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
  6299. @end deffn
  6300. @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
  6301. Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
  6302. @end deffn
  6303. @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
  6304. Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
  6305. the flash clock.
  6306. @end deffn
  6307. @end deffn
  6308. @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
  6309. W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
  6310. are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
  6311. The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
  6312. correct bank config.
  6313. @example
  6314. flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
  6315. @end example
  6316. @end deffn
  6317. @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
  6318. All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
  6319. This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  6320. @end deffn
  6321. @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
  6322. All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
  6323. This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
  6324. Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
  6325. @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
  6326. Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
  6327. @end deffn
  6328. @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
  6329. Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
  6330. @end deffn
  6331. @end deffn
  6332. @section NAND Flash Commands
  6333. @cindex NAND
  6334. Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
  6335. and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
  6336. commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
  6337. NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
  6338. size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
  6339. number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
  6340. page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
  6341. Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
  6342. of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
  6343. One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
  6344. is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
  6345. ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
  6346. blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
  6347. are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
  6348. manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
  6349. use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
  6350. support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
  6351. that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
  6352. with techniques such as wear leveling.
  6353. Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
  6354. support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
  6355. Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
  6356. Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
  6357. geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
  6358. every 512 bytes of data.
  6359. You will need to make sure that any data you write using
  6360. OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
  6361. that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
  6362. writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
  6363. ECC mode is used.
  6364. The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
  6365. @enumerate
  6366. @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
  6367. @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
  6368. passing parameters as needed by the controller.
  6369. @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
  6370. @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
  6371. such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
  6372. to access that device.
  6373. @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
  6374. @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
  6375. via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
  6376. boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
  6377. de-brick a board.
  6378. @end enumerate
  6379. @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
  6380. flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
  6381. This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
  6382. are only 32 bits wide.
  6383. (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
  6384. is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
  6385. Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
  6386. modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
  6387. @anchor{nandconfiguration}
  6388. @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
  6389. @cindex NAND configuration
  6390. NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
  6391. plus some additional configuration that's done after
  6392. OpenOCD has initialized.
  6393. @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
  6394. Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
  6395. after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
  6396. In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
  6397. operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
  6398. they were a single (larger) device.
  6399. In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
  6400. commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
  6401. @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
  6402. initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
  6403. configuration files, not interactively.
  6404. @itemize @bullet
  6405. @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
  6406. in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
  6407. @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
  6408. associated with the NAND device being declared.
  6409. @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
  6410. @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
  6411. commands to the NAND controller.
  6412. @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
  6413. @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
  6414. additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
  6415. for more information.
  6416. @end itemize
  6417. @end deffn
  6418. @deffn {Command} {nand list}
  6419. Prints a summary of each device declared
  6420. using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
  6421. Note that un-probed devices show no details.
  6422. @example
  6423. > nand list
  6424. #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
  6425. blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
  6426. #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
  6427. blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
  6428. >
  6429. @end example
  6430. @end deffn
  6431. @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
  6432. Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
  6433. like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
  6434. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6435. You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
  6436. it with most other NAND commands.
  6437. @end deffn
  6438. @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
  6439. @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
  6440. @cindex NAND reading
  6441. Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
  6442. starting at the specified offset.
  6443. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6444. Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
  6445. on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
  6446. The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
  6447. device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
  6448. associated with each such page may also be accessed.
  6449. @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
  6450. was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
  6451. and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
  6452. method which handled that error correction.
  6453. By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
  6454. Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
  6455. @itemize @bullet
  6456. @item no oob_* parameter
  6457. @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
  6458. @item @code{oob_raw}
  6459. @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
  6460. the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
  6461. spare areas associated with each data page.
  6462. Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
  6463. what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
  6464. controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
  6465. @item @code{oob_only}
  6466. @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
  6467. be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
  6468. spare areas associated with each data page.
  6469. @end itemize
  6470. @end deffn
  6471. @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
  6472. @cindex NAND erasing
  6473. @cindex NAND programming
  6474. Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
  6475. specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
  6476. Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
  6477. block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
  6478. If those parameters are not specified,
  6479. the whole NAND chip will be erased.
  6480. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6481. @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
  6482. to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
  6483. block marker.
  6484. For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
  6485. will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
  6486. @end deffn
  6487. @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
  6488. @cindex NAND writing
  6489. @cindex NAND programming
  6490. Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
  6491. starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
  6492. have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
  6493. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6494. Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
  6495. on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
  6496. The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
  6497. All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
  6498. past the end of the device.
  6499. Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
  6500. page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
  6501. if that's being written.)
  6502. @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
  6503. ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
  6504. but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
  6505. Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
  6506. NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
  6507. if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
  6508. @itemize @bullet
  6509. @item no oob_* parameter
  6510. @*File has only page data, which is written.
  6511. If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
  6512. Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
  6513. a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
  6514. with hardware-computed ECC data.
  6515. @item @code{oob_only}
  6516. @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
  6517. Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
  6518. option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
  6519. You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
  6520. @item @code{oob_raw}
  6521. @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
  6522. If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
  6523. un-altered OOB.
  6524. Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
  6525. a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
  6526. before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
  6527. @item @code{oob_softecc}
  6528. @*File has only page data, which is written.
  6529. The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
  6530. software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
  6531. You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
  6532. the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
  6533. @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
  6534. @*File has only page data, which is written.
  6535. The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
  6536. specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
  6537. You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
  6538. the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
  6539. @end itemize
  6540. @end deffn
  6541. @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
  6542. @cindex NAND verification
  6543. @cindex NAND programming
  6544. Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
  6545. specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
  6546. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6547. Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
  6548. on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
  6549. The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
  6550. All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
  6551. flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
  6552. As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
  6553. space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
  6554. The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
  6555. and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
  6556. can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
  6557. @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
  6558. driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
  6559. hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
  6560. be removed in a future release.
  6561. @end deffn
  6562. @subsection Other NAND commands
  6563. @cindex NAND other commands
  6564. @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
  6565. Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
  6566. device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
  6567. device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
  6568. continues for @var{length} bytes.
  6569. Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
  6570. block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
  6571. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6572. @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
  6573. with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
  6574. driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
  6575. @end deffn
  6576. @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
  6577. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6578. This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
  6579. devices which have been probed this also prints any known
  6580. status for each block.
  6581. @end deffn
  6582. @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  6583. Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
  6584. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6585. This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
  6586. value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
  6587. the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
  6588. methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
  6589. this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
  6590. When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
  6591. data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
  6592. writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
  6593. raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
  6594. bypassing hardware ECC logic.
  6595. @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
  6596. with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
  6597. @end deffn
  6598. @anchor{nanddriverlist}
  6599. @subsection NAND Driver List
  6600. As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
  6601. driver-specific options and behaviors.
  6602. Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
  6603. @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
  6604. This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
  6605. Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
  6606. address of the ECC controller.
  6607. @example
  6608. nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
  6609. @end example
  6610. AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
  6611. @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
  6612. disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
  6613. additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
  6614. controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
  6615. @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
  6616. Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
  6617. parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6618. @end deffn
  6619. @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
  6620. Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
  6621. parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6622. @end deffn
  6623. For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
  6624. properly configured for input or output.
  6625. @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
  6626. Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
  6627. parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
  6628. is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
  6629. @end deffn
  6630. @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
  6631. Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
  6632. parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
  6633. is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
  6634. @end deffn
  6635. @end deffn
  6636. @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
  6637. This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
  6638. chips from Texas Instruments.
  6639. It takes three extra parameters:
  6640. address of the NAND chip;
  6641. hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
  6642. @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
  6643. address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
  6644. @example
  6645. nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
  6646. @end example
  6647. All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
  6648. and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
  6649. The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
  6650. to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
  6651. the @command{nand raw_access} command.
  6652. @end deffn
  6653. @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
  6654. These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
  6655. parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
  6656. @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
  6657. Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
  6658. MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
  6659. The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
  6660. @end deffn
  6661. At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
  6662. and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
  6663. to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
  6664. in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
  6665. @end deffn
  6666. @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
  6667. @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
  6668. This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
  6669. should work for this chip as well.
  6670. @end deffn
  6671. @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
  6672. This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
  6673. chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
  6674. The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
  6675. @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
  6676. and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
  6677. main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
  6678. @example
  6679. nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
  6680. @end example
  6681. @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
  6682. Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
  6683. without parameter query status.
  6684. @end deffn
  6685. @end deffn
  6686. @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
  6687. These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
  6688. parameter: the address of the controller.
  6689. @example
  6690. nand device orion 0xd8000000
  6691. @end example
  6692. These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
  6693. At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
  6694. or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
  6695. change any behavior.
  6696. @end deffn
  6697. @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
  6698. @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
  6699. @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
  6700. @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
  6701. @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
  6702. These S3C family controllers don't have any special
  6703. @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
  6704. specialized commands.
  6705. At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
  6706. or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
  6707. change any behavior.
  6708. @end deffn
  6709. @node Flash Programming
  6710. @chapter Flash Programming
  6711. OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
  6712. Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
  6713. or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
  6714. @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
  6715. OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
  6716. The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
  6717. @enumerate
  6718. @item 'init' is executed.
  6719. @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
  6720. @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
  6721. @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
  6722. @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
  6723. @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
  6724. @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
  6725. @end enumerate
  6726. An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
  6727. @example
  6728. # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
  6729. # are optional parameters
  6730. openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
  6731. -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
  6732. # binary files need the flash address passing
  6733. openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
  6734. -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
  6735. @end example
  6736. @node PLD/FPGA Commands
  6737. @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
  6738. @cindex PLD
  6739. @cindex FPGA
  6740. Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
  6741. Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
  6742. OpenOCD can support programming them.
  6743. Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
  6744. there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
  6745. they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
  6746. Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
  6747. @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
  6748. As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
  6749. OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
  6750. Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
  6751. They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
  6752. and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
  6753. @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
  6754. Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
  6755. using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
  6756. The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
  6757. behavior.
  6758. @end deffn
  6759. @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
  6760. Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
  6761. @end deffn
  6762. @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
  6763. Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
  6764. The file format must be inferred by the driver.
  6765. @end deffn
  6766. @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
  6767. Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
  6768. definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
  6769. that particular type of PLD.
  6770. @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
  6771. Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
  6772. It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
  6773. If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
  6774. loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
  6775. breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
  6776. @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
  6777. Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
  6778. for FPGA @var{num}.
  6779. @end deffn
  6780. @end deffn
  6781. @node General Commands
  6782. @chapter General Commands
  6783. @cindex commands
  6784. The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
  6785. you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
  6786. commands are documented elsewhere.
  6787. Intent:
  6788. @itemize @bullet
  6789. @item @b{Source Of Commands}
  6790. @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
  6791. elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
  6792. or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
  6793. @item @b{From the human}
  6794. @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
  6795. or via GDB (default port 3333).
  6796. To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
  6797. command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
  6798. command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
  6799. @item @b{Machine Interface}
  6800. The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
  6801. port is 5555.
  6802. @end itemize
  6803. @section Server Commands
  6804. @deffn {Command} {exit}
  6805. Exits the current telnet session.
  6806. @end deffn
  6807. @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
  6808. With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
  6809. Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
  6810. Not every command provides helptext.
  6811. Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
  6812. explicitly noted in parenthesis.
  6813. In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
  6814. which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
  6815. @end deffn
  6816. @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
  6817. Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
  6818. If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
  6819. (This option is strongly discouraged.)
  6820. Useful in connection with script files
  6821. (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
  6822. @end deffn
  6823. @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
  6824. Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
  6825. other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
  6826. non-zero exit code to the parent process.
  6827. Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
  6828. @example
  6829. # redefine shutdown
  6830. rename shutdown original_shutdown
  6831. proc shutdown @{@} @{
  6832. puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
  6833. # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
  6834. original_shutdown
  6835. @}
  6836. @end example
  6837. If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
  6838. or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
  6839. @end deffn
  6840. @anchor{debuglevel}
  6841. @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
  6842. @cindex message level
  6843. Display debug level.
  6844. If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
  6845. This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
  6846. Level 0 is error messages only;
  6847. level 1 adds warnings;
  6848. level 2 adds informational messages;
  6849. level 3 adds debugging messages;
  6850. and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
  6851. The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
  6852. the command line along with the location of that log
  6853. file (which is normally the server's standard output).
  6854. @xref{Running}.
  6855. @end deffn
  6856. @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
  6857. Logs a message at "user" priority.
  6858. Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
  6859. @example
  6860. echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
  6861. @end example
  6862. @end deffn
  6863. @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
  6864. Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
  6865. the default log output channel is stderr.
  6866. @end deffn
  6867. @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
  6868. Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
  6869. @end deffn
  6870. @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
  6871. Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
  6872. TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
  6873. interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
  6874. 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
  6875. @end deffn
  6876. @anchor{targetstatehandling}
  6877. @section Target State handling
  6878. @cindex reset
  6879. @cindex halt
  6880. @cindex target initialization
  6881. In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
  6882. shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
  6883. These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
  6884. a current target which is used to perform the
  6885. various operations. The current target may be changed
  6886. by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
  6887. target which should become current.
  6888. @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
  6889. Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
  6890. The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
  6891. registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
  6892. registers may be accessible while the target is running.
  6893. @emph{With no arguments}:
  6894. list all available registers for the current target,
  6895. showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
  6896. For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
  6897. which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
  6898. are flagged as such.
  6899. @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
  6900. Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
  6901. bypassing any internal cache.
  6902. @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
  6903. Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
  6904. so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
  6905. of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
  6906. (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
  6907. relevant module will flush such values.
  6908. Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
  6909. Debug and trace infrastructure:
  6910. @example
  6911. > reg
  6912. ===== ARM registers
  6913. (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
  6914. (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
  6915. (2) r2 (/32)
  6916. ...
  6917. (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
  6918. >
  6919. @end example
  6920. @end deffn
  6921. @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
  6922. @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
  6923. The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
  6924. which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
  6925. Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
  6926. or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
  6927. (and enter debug mode).
  6928. Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
  6929. @quotation Warning
  6930. On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
  6931. often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
  6932. This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
  6933. power mode by gating the core clock;
  6934. but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
  6935. One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
  6936. interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
  6937. at least until the interrupt handler completes.
  6938. However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
  6939. and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
  6940. Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
  6941. A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
  6942. work with a JTAG debugger.
  6943. Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
  6944. @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
  6945. (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
  6946. newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
  6947. Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
  6948. power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
  6949. @end quotation
  6950. @end deffn
  6951. @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
  6952. Resume the target at its current code position,
  6953. or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
  6954. OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
  6955. @end deffn
  6956. @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
  6957. Single-step the target at its current code position,
  6958. or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
  6959. @end deffn
  6960. @anchor{resetcommand}
  6961. @deffn {Command} {reset}
  6962. @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
  6963. @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
  6964. @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
  6965. Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
  6966. @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
  6967. events will fire during the reset sequence.}
  6968. The optional parameter specifies what should
  6969. happen after the reset.
  6970. If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
  6971. The other options will not work on all systems.
  6972. @xref{Reset Configuration}.
  6973. @itemize @minus
  6974. @item @b{run} Let the target run
  6975. @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
  6976. @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
  6977. @end itemize
  6978. @end deffn
  6979. @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
  6980. Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
  6981. when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
  6982. released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
  6983. then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
  6984. the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
  6985. state.
  6986. @end deffn
  6987. @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
  6988. @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
  6989. Set values of reset signals.
  6990. Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
  6991. The @var{signal} parameter values may be
  6992. @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
  6993. @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
  6994. The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
  6995. to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
  6996. signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
  6997. @xref{Reset Configuration}.
  6998. Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
  6999. If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
  7000. the signal will not be modified.
  7001. @quotation Note
  7002. TRST is specially handled.
  7003. It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
  7004. So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
  7005. or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
  7006. JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
  7007. instead of the TRST signal.
  7008. And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
  7009. the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
  7010. TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
  7011. with handlers for that event.
  7012. @end quotation
  7013. @end deffn
  7014. @anchor{memoryaccess}
  7015. @section Memory access commands
  7016. @cindex memory access
  7017. These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
  7018. system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
  7019. special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
  7020. SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
  7021. @enumerate
  7022. @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
  7023. to change the current target.
  7024. @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
  7025. Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
  7026. about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
  7027. @end enumerate
  7028. @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
  7029. @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
  7030. @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
  7031. @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
  7032. Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
  7033. 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
  7034. 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
  7035. or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
  7036. When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
  7037. @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
  7038. Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
  7039. @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
  7040. If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
  7041. (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
  7042. see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
  7043. @end deffn
  7044. @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
  7045. @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
  7046. @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
  7047. @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
  7048. Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
  7049. @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
  7050. at the specified address @var{addr}.
  7051. When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
  7052. @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
  7053. Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
  7054. @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
  7055. If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
  7056. @end deffn
  7057. @anchor{imageaccess}
  7058. @section Image loading commands
  7059. @cindex image loading
  7060. @cindex image dumping
  7061. @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
  7062. Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
  7063. binary file named @var{filename}.
  7064. @end deffn
  7065. @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
  7066. Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
  7067. current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
  7068. @end deffn
  7069. @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
  7070. Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
  7071. testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
  7072. host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
  7073. can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
  7074. Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
  7075. memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
  7076. target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
  7077. separately.
  7078. @end deffn
  7079. @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
  7080. Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
  7081. The file format may optionally be specified
  7082. (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
  7083. In addition the following arguments may be specified:
  7084. @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
  7085. @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
  7086. @example
  7087. proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
  7088. # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
  7089. # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
  7090. load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
  7091. $address $length
  7092. @}
  7093. @end example
  7094. @end deffn
  7095. @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
  7096. Displays image section sizes and addresses
  7097. as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
  7098. starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
  7099. The file format may optionally be specified
  7100. (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
  7101. @end deffn
  7102. @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
  7103. Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
  7104. The file format may optionally be specified
  7105. (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
  7106. This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
  7107. @end deffn
  7108. @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
  7109. Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
  7110. The file format may optionally be specified
  7111. (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
  7112. This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
  7113. @end deffn
  7114. @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
  7115. @cindex breakpoint
  7116. @cindex watchpoint
  7117. CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
  7118. hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
  7119. watchpoints.
  7120. In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
  7121. @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
  7122. With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
  7123. Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
  7124. at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
  7125. This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
  7126. in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
  7127. (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
  7128. for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
  7129. @end deffn
  7130. @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
  7131. Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
  7132. @end deffn
  7133. @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
  7134. Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
  7135. @end deffn
  7136. @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
  7137. With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
  7138. Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
  7139. The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
  7140. the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
  7141. defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
  7142. If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
  7143. the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
  7144. using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
  7145. @end deffn
  7146. @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
  7147. Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
  7148. memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
  7149. The specification is independent of the target architecture.
  7150. Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
  7151. that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
  7152. running, can be used.
  7153. This interface is especially of interest for targets without
  7154. Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
  7155. applicable because of real-time constraints.
  7156. @quotation Note
  7157. The current implementation supports only single target devices.
  7158. @end quotation
  7159. The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
  7160. unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
  7161. communication, respectively.
  7162. @quotation Note
  7163. The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
  7164. They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
  7165. example.
  7166. @end quotation
  7167. Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
  7168. assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
  7169. of TCP/IP connections.
  7170. @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
  7171. Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
  7172. Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
  7173. identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
  7174. @var{size} bytes.
  7175. @end deffn
  7176. @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
  7177. Start RTT.
  7178. If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
  7179. @end deffn
  7180. @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
  7181. Stop RTT.
  7182. @end deffn
  7183. @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
  7184. Display the polling interval.
  7185. If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
  7186. The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
  7187. checked for new data.
  7188. @end deffn
  7189. @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
  7190. Display a list of all channels and their properties.
  7191. @end deffn
  7192. @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
  7193. Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
  7194. The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
  7195. @end deffn
  7196. @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
  7197. Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
  7198. @end deffn
  7199. @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
  7200. Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
  7201. @end deffn
  7202. The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
  7203. on the target device.
  7204. @example
  7205. resume
  7206. rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
  7207. rtt start
  7208. rtt server start 9090 0
  7209. @end example
  7210. In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
  7211. starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
  7212. TCP/IP port 9090.
  7213. @section Misc Commands
  7214. @cindex profiling
  7215. @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
  7216. Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
  7217. which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
  7218. Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
  7219. format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
  7220. limit the address range.
  7221. @end deffn
  7222. @deffn {Command} {version}
  7223. Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
  7224. @end deffn
  7225. @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
  7226. Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
  7227. to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
  7228. @end deffn
  7229. @node Architecture and Core Commands
  7230. @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
  7231. @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
  7232. @cindex Core Specific Commands
  7233. Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
  7234. OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
  7235. Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
  7236. exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
  7237. @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
  7238. @section ARM Hardware Tracing
  7239. @cindex tracing
  7240. @cindex ETM
  7241. @cindex ETB
  7242. CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
  7243. based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
  7244. address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
  7245. @itemize
  7246. @item
  7247. Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
  7248. trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
  7249. supports such an interface.
  7250. (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
  7251. and trace port support.)
  7252. Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
  7253. and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
  7254. buffer several megabytes of trace data.
  7255. Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
  7256. in the board-specific configuration file.
  7257. @item
  7258. If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
  7259. has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
  7260. dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
  7261. Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
  7262. (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
  7263. @end itemize
  7264. ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
  7265. @quotation Issues
  7266. ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
  7267. parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
  7268. ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
  7269. hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
  7270. watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
  7271. @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
  7272. dummy trace port driver}.
  7273. It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
  7274. as well as tracing only during specific states
  7275. (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
  7276. There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
  7277. analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
  7278. It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
  7279. with the current XScale trace support, or should be
  7280. shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
  7281. At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
  7282. for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
  7283. work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
  7284. this original style of JTAG access.
  7285. @end quotation
  7286. @subsection ETM Configuration
  7287. ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
  7288. @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
  7289. Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
  7290. with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
  7291. Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
  7292. which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
  7293. using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
  7294. that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
  7295. The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
  7296. except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
  7297. support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
  7298. (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
  7299. the selected port width and mode are supported.)
  7300. The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
  7301. or @option{demultiplexed}.
  7302. The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
  7303. @quotation Warning
  7304. With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
  7305. @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
  7306. This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
  7307. previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
  7308. @end quotation
  7309. @quotation Note
  7310. You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
  7311. Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
  7312. Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
  7313. what CPU activities are traced.
  7314. @end quotation
  7315. @end deffn
  7316. @deffn {Command} {etm info}
  7317. Displays information about the current target's ETM.
  7318. This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
  7319. as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
  7320. from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
  7321. @end deffn
  7322. @deffn {Command} {etm status}
  7323. Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
  7324. is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
  7325. Did trace data overflow?
  7326. Was it triggered?
  7327. @end deffn
  7328. @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
  7329. Displays what data that ETM will collect.
  7330. If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
  7331. When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
  7332. and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
  7333. @itemize
  7334. @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
  7335. when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
  7336. The value is one of
  7337. @option{none} (save nothing),
  7338. @option{data} (save data),
  7339. @option{address} (save addresses),
  7340. @option{all} (save data and addresses)
  7341. @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
  7342. @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
  7343. cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
  7344. Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
  7345. @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
  7346. Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
  7347. trace stream without an image of the code.
  7348. @end itemize
  7349. @end deffn
  7350. @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  7351. Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
  7352. enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
  7353. The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
  7354. Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
  7355. By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
  7356. processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
  7357. more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
  7358. @end deffn
  7359. @subsection ETM Trace Operation
  7360. After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
  7361. That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
  7362. It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
  7363. To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
  7364. various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
  7365. For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
  7366. @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
  7367. Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
  7368. and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
  7369. of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
  7370. Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
  7371. @itemize
  7372. @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
  7373. it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
  7374. for instruction access within that function's body.
  7375. @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
  7376. it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
  7377. tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
  7378. exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
  7379. @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
  7380. combining one of the above models with a counter.
  7381. @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
  7382. using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
  7383. @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
  7384. model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
  7385. @item @emph{... more}
  7386. @end itemize
  7387. At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
  7388. procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
  7389. @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
  7390. Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
  7391. Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
  7392. @end deffn
  7393. @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
  7394. Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
  7395. @end deffn
  7396. @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
  7397. Opens an image file.
  7398. @end deffn
  7399. @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
  7400. Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
  7401. @end deffn
  7402. @deffn {Command} {etm start}
  7403. Starts trace data collection.
  7404. @end deffn
  7405. @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
  7406. Stops trace data collection.
  7407. @end deffn
  7408. @anchor{traceportdrivers}
  7409. @subsection Trace Port Drivers
  7410. To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
  7411. @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
  7412. Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
  7413. not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
  7414. @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
  7415. any trace data collection.}
  7416. @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
  7417. Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
  7418. @end deffn
  7419. @end deffn
  7420. @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
  7421. Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
  7422. to use on-chip ETB memory.
  7423. @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
  7424. Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
  7425. You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
  7426. @end deffn
  7427. @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
  7428. This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
  7429. ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
  7430. It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
  7431. trace trigger becomes active.
  7432. @itemize
  7433. @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
  7434. recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
  7435. afterwards.
  7436. @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
  7437. recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
  7438. Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
  7439. what caused that event to happen.
  7440. @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
  7441. recording data almost exclusively after the event.
  7442. This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
  7443. how the event caused trouble.
  7444. @end itemize
  7445. @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
  7446. @end deffn
  7447. @end deffn
  7448. @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
  7449. @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
  7450. @cindex CTI
  7451. The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
  7452. that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
  7453. other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
  7454. CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
  7455. CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
  7456. the @emph{cti} group of commands.
  7457. @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
  7458. Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
  7459. @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
  7460. on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
  7461. new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
  7462. including additional configuration.
  7463. @end deffn
  7464. @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
  7465. Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
  7466. @end deffn
  7467. @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
  7468. Displays a register dump of the CTI.
  7469. @end deffn
  7470. @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
  7471. Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
  7472. @end deffn
  7473. @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
  7474. Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
  7475. @end deffn
  7476. @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
  7477. Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
  7478. @end deffn
  7479. @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
  7480. Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
  7481. gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
  7482. @end deffn
  7483. @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
  7484. Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
  7485. of the CTI.
  7486. @end deffn
  7487. @deffn {Command} {cti names}
  7488. Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
  7489. useful in TCL scripting.
  7490. @end deffn
  7491. @section Generic ARM
  7492. @cindex ARM
  7493. These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
  7494. They are available in addition to other core-specific
  7495. commands that may be available.
  7496. @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
  7497. Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
  7498. either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
  7499. The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
  7500. (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
  7501. that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
  7502. @end deffn
  7503. @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
  7504. @cindex disassemble
  7505. Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
  7506. If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
  7507. If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
  7508. Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
  7509. else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
  7510. (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
  7511. those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
  7512. Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
  7513. so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
  7514. see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
  7515. Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
  7516. with a handful of exceptions.
  7517. ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
  7518. @end deffn
  7519. @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
  7520. Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
  7521. passing parameters @var{CRn},
  7522. @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
  7523. and using the MCR instruction.
  7524. (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
  7525. an ARM register.)
  7526. @end deffn
  7527. @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
  7528. Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
  7529. @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
  7530. and the MRC instruction.
  7531. Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
  7532. (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
  7533. an ARM register.)
  7534. @end deffn
  7535. @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
  7536. Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
  7537. core mode if necessary.
  7538. @end deffn
  7539. @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7540. @cindex ARM semihosting
  7541. Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
  7542. Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
  7543. I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
  7544. is running. The target application must be linked against a library
  7545. implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
  7546. requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
  7547. Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
  7548. @end deffn
  7549. @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7550. @cindex ARM semihosting
  7551. Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
  7552. @example
  7553. arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
  7554. @end example
  7555. This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
  7556. the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
  7557. standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
  7558. programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
  7559. @end deffn
  7560. @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7561. @cindex ARM semihosting
  7562. Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
  7563. status.
  7564. Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
  7565. File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
  7566. interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
  7567. debugger.
  7568. @end deffn
  7569. @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7570. @cindex ARM semihosting
  7571. Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
  7572. When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
  7573. things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
  7574. the value returned by the target.
  7575. When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
  7576. by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
  7577. debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
  7578. encountering a break.
  7579. In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
  7580. return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
  7581. to the debugger.
  7582. The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
  7583. to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
  7584. request or equivalent").
  7585. To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
  7586. this option (default: disabled).
  7587. @end deffn
  7588. @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
  7589. @cindex ARMv4
  7590. @cindex ARMv5
  7591. The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
  7592. and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
  7593. That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
  7594. variant.
  7595. @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
  7596. @cindex ARM7
  7597. @cindex ARM9
  7598. These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
  7599. ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
  7600. They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
  7601. and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
  7602. @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7603. Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
  7604. EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
  7605. instead of breakpoints.
  7606. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7607. This should be
  7608. safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
  7609. This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
  7610. including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
  7611. @end deffn
  7612. @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7613. @cindex DCC
  7614. Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
  7615. channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
  7616. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7617. DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
  7618. unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
  7619. with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
  7620. @end deffn
  7621. @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7622. Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
  7623. that don't check completion of the operation.
  7624. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7625. This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
  7626. cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
  7627. speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
  7628. @end deffn
  7629. @subsection ARM9 specific commands
  7630. @cindex ARM9
  7631. ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
  7632. integer processors.
  7633. Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
  7634. @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
  7635. @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
  7636. @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
  7637. @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
  7638. @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
  7639. @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
  7640. @cindex vector_catch
  7641. Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
  7642. for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
  7643. You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
  7644. so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
  7645. to those hardware vectors.
  7646. This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
  7647. If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
  7648. vector catch hardware to intercept
  7649. @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
  7650. @option{none} of them,
  7651. or a list with one or more of the following:
  7652. @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
  7653. @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
  7654. @end deffn
  7655. @subsection ARM920T specific commands
  7656. @cindex ARM920T
  7657. These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
  7658. which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
  7659. built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
  7660. They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
  7661. and ARM9 commands.
  7662. @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
  7663. Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
  7664. is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
  7665. @end deffn
  7666. @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
  7667. Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
  7668. else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
  7669. This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
  7670. shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
  7671. (Not all registers can be written.)
  7672. @end deffn
  7673. @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
  7674. Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
  7675. @end deffn
  7676. @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
  7677. Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
  7678. @end deffn
  7679. @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
  7680. @cindex ARM926ej-s
  7681. These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
  7682. which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
  7683. based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
  7684. They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
  7685. and ARM9 commands.
  7686. The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
  7687. they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
  7688. @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
  7689. Print information about the caches found.
  7690. @end deffn
  7691. @subsection ARM966E specific commands
  7692. @cindex ARM966E
  7693. These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
  7694. which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
  7695. They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
  7696. and ARM9 commands.
  7697. @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
  7698. Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
  7699. else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
  7700. The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
  7701. ARM966E-S TRM.
  7702. There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
  7703. as required for BIST support.
  7704. @end deffn
  7705. @subsection XScale specific commands
  7706. @cindex XScale
  7707. Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
  7708. The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
  7709. (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
  7710. code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
  7711. must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
  7712. handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
  7713. mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
  7714. handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
  7715. To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
  7716. vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
  7717. individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
  7718. the mini-IC.
  7719. It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
  7720. table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
  7721. makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
  7722. code layout in memory:
  7723. @example
  7724. _vectors:
  7725. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7726. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7727. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7728. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7729. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7730. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7731. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7732. ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
  7733. .org 0x100
  7734. .long real_reset_vector
  7735. .long real_ui_handler
  7736. .long real_swi_handler
  7737. .long real_pf_abort
  7738. .long real_data_abort
  7739. .long 0 /* unused */
  7740. .long real_irq_handler
  7741. .long real_fiq_handler
  7742. @end example
  7743. Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
  7744. vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
  7745. system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
  7746. is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
  7747. using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
  7748. value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
  7749. halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
  7750. table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
  7751. that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
  7752. need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
  7753. start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
  7754. but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
  7755. accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
  7756. been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
  7757. in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
  7758. situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
  7759. software.
  7760. The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
  7761. the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
  7762. debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
  7763. 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
  7764. XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
  7765. watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
  7766. functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
  7767. command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
  7768. power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
  7769. watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
  7770. four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
  7771. at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
  7772. length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
  7773. These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
  7774. which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
  7775. @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
  7776. Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
  7777. @end deffn
  7778. @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
  7779. Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
  7780. @end deffn
  7781. @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
  7782. Displays information about the CPU caches.
  7783. @end deffn
  7784. @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
  7785. Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
  7786. else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
  7787. @end deffn
  7788. @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
  7789. Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
  7790. @end deffn
  7791. @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7792. Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
  7793. @end deffn
  7794. @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
  7795. Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
  7796. @end deffn
  7797. @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7798. Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
  7799. @end deffn
  7800. @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7801. Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
  7802. @end deffn
  7803. @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
  7804. Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
  7805. enabling or disabling the trace buffer
  7806. and modifying how it is emptied.
  7807. @end deffn
  7808. @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
  7809. Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
  7810. its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
  7811. The image @var{type} may be one of
  7812. @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
  7813. @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
  7814. @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
  7815. @end deffn
  7816. @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
  7817. @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
  7818. @cindex vector_catch
  7819. Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
  7820. If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
  7821. The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
  7822. @example
  7823. 0x01 Trap Reset
  7824. 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
  7825. 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
  7826. 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
  7827. 0x10 Trap Data Abort
  7828. 0x20 reserved
  7829. 0x40 Trap IRQ
  7830. 0x80 Trap FIQ
  7831. @end example
  7832. @end deffn
  7833. @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
  7834. @cindex vector_table
  7835. Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
  7836. low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
  7837. holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
  7838. points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
  7839. @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
  7840. Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
  7841. @end deffn
  7842. @section ARMv6 Architecture
  7843. @cindex ARMv6
  7844. @subsection ARM11 specific commands
  7845. @cindex ARM11
  7846. @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7847. Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
  7848. which is enabled by default.
  7849. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7850. Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
  7851. They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
  7852. word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
  7853. instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
  7854. This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
  7855. @end deffn
  7856. @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7857. Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
  7858. which is enabled by default.
  7859. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
  7860. When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
  7861. @end deffn
  7862. @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
  7863. Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
  7864. IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
  7865. they are disabled by default.
  7866. If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
  7867. @end deffn
  7868. @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
  7869. @cindex vector_catch
  7870. Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
  7871. coprocessor 14 register 7.
  7872. If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
  7873. Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
  7874. for certain hardware events.
  7875. The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
  7876. coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
  7877. cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
  7878. @end deffn
  7879. @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
  7880. @cindex ARMv7
  7881. @cindex ARMv8
  7882. @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
  7883. @cindex Cortex-A
  7884. @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
  7885. display information about target caches
  7886. @end deffn
  7887. @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
  7888. Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
  7889. mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
  7890. to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
  7891. Defaults to 'off'.
  7892. @end deffn
  7893. @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
  7894. Initialize core debug
  7895. Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
  7896. @end deffn
  7897. @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
  7898. Display/set the current SMP mode
  7899. @end deffn
  7900. @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
  7901. Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
  7902. @end deffn
  7903. @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  7904. Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
  7905. @end deffn
  7906. @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
  7907. configure l2x cache
  7908. @end deffn
  7909. @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
  7910. Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
  7911. memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
  7912. @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
  7913. possible (4096) entries are printed.
  7914. @end deffn
  7915. @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
  7916. @cindex Cortex-R
  7917. @deffn {Command} {cortex_r dbginit}
  7918. Initialize core debug
  7919. Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
  7920. @end deffn
  7921. @deffn {Command} {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  7922. Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
  7923. @end deffn
  7924. @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
  7925. @cindex tracing
  7926. @cindex SWO
  7927. @cindex SWV
  7928. @cindex TPIU
  7929. ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
  7930. information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
  7931. through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
  7932. configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
  7933. ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
  7934. own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
  7935. block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
  7936. which causes quite some confusion.
  7937. The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
  7938. driver that detects at runtime the features available.
  7939. The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
  7940. A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
  7941. the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
  7942. @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
  7943. Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
  7944. for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
  7945. @end deffn
  7946. @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
  7947. Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
  7948. Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
  7949. which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
  7950. @itemize @bullet
  7951. @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
  7952. This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
  7953. as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
  7954. @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
  7955. You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
  7956. @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
  7957. @end itemize
  7958. @end deffn
  7959. @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
  7960. Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
  7961. @end deffn
  7962. @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
  7963. Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
  7964. These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
  7965. at any time after the initialization, too.
  7966. @end deffn
  7967. @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
  7968. Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
  7969. individually queried, to return its current value.
  7970. The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
  7971. @end deffn
  7972. @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
  7973. The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
  7974. to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
  7975. using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
  7976. @itemize @bullet
  7977. @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
  7978. TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
  7979. @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
  7980. @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
  7981. @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
  7982. to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
  7983. @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
  7984. protocol used for trace data:
  7985. @itemize @minus
  7986. @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
  7987. data bits (default);
  7988. @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
  7989. @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
  7990. @end itemize
  7991. @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
  7992. a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
  7993. @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
  7994. are defined for TPIU/SWO.
  7995. A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
  7996. of the TPIU.
  7997. @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
  7998. the destination of the trace data:
  7999. @itemize @minus
  8000. @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
  8001. output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
  8002. @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
  8003. and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
  8004. @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
  8005. trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
  8006. each connected client;
  8007. @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
  8008. gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
  8009. either a regular file or a named pipe.
  8010. @end itemize
  8011. @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
  8012. Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
  8013. Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
  8014. @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
  8015. @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
  8016. in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
  8017. @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
  8018. maximum supported rate automatically.
  8019. @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
  8020. of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
  8021. protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
  8022. @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
  8023. should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
  8024. default value is @var{0}.
  8025. @end itemize
  8026. @end deffn
  8027. @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
  8028. Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
  8029. to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
  8030. If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
  8031. data.
  8032. This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
  8033. after the @command{init}.
  8034. @end deffn
  8035. @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
  8036. Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
  8037. @end deffn
  8038. Example usage:
  8039. @enumerate
  8040. @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
  8041. PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
  8042. enough to:
  8043. @example
  8044. #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
  8045. ...
  8046. ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
  8047. ...
  8048. @end example
  8049. (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
  8050. for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
  8051. blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
  8052. ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
  8053. @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
  8054. @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
  8055. @example
  8056. $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
  8057. $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
  8058. @end example
  8059. (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
  8060. baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
  8061. @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
  8062. @item OpenOCD invocation line:
  8063. @example
  8064. openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
  8065. -c "transport select hla_swd" \
  8066. -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
  8067. -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
  8068. -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
  8069. -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
  8070. @end example
  8071. @end enumerate
  8072. @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
  8073. @cindex tracing
  8074. @cindex SWO
  8075. @cindex SWV
  8076. @cindex ITM
  8077. @cindex ETM
  8078. @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
  8079. Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
  8080. from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
  8081. @end deffn
  8082. @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
  8083. Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
  8084. @end deffn
  8085. @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
  8086. @cindex Cortex-M
  8087. @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
  8088. Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
  8089. The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
  8090. get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
  8091. pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
  8092. the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
  8093. are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
  8094. the step command leaves with the core running.
  8095. The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
  8096. enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
  8097. for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
  8098. FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
  8099. Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
  8100. option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
  8101. is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
  8102. does.
  8103. Default is @option{auto}.
  8104. @end deffn
  8105. @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
  8106. @cindex vector_catch
  8107. Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
  8108. for certain hardware events.
  8109. Parameters request interception of
  8110. @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
  8111. @option{none} of them,
  8112. or one or more of the following:
  8113. @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
  8114. @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
  8115. @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
  8116. @option{irq_err},
  8117. @option{state_err},
  8118. @option{chk_err}, or
  8119. @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
  8120. @option{reset}.
  8121. If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
  8122. MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
  8123. are mapped to HardFault.
  8124. UsageFault checks for
  8125. divide-by-zero and unaligned access
  8126. must also be explicitly enabled.
  8127. This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
  8128. @end deffn
  8129. @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
  8130. Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
  8131. @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
  8132. @itemize @minus
  8133. @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
  8134. @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
  8135. @end itemize
  8136. Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
  8137. This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
  8138. are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
  8139. to manually reset the peripherals.
  8140. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  8141. Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
  8142. instead.
  8143. @end deffn
  8144. @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
  8145. @cindex ARMv8-A
  8146. @cindex aarch64
  8147. @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
  8148. Display information about target caches
  8149. @end deffn
  8150. @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
  8151. This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
  8152. indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
  8153. target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
  8154. @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
  8155. However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
  8156. @end deffn
  8157. @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
  8158. @cindex disassemble
  8159. Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
  8160. If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
  8161. @end deffn
  8162. @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
  8163. Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
  8164. are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
  8165. halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
  8166. group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
  8167. @end deffn
  8168. @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
  8169. Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
  8170. @option{on}.
  8171. @end deffn
  8172. @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
  8173. Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
  8174. Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
  8175. @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
  8176. the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
  8177. Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
  8178. @end deffn
  8179. @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
  8180. eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
  8181. provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
  8182. @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
  8183. @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
  8184. Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
  8185. option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
  8186. @end deffn
  8187. @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
  8188. Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
  8189. control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
  8190. @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
  8191. By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
  8192. @end deffn
  8193. @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
  8194. @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
  8195. Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
  8196. when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
  8197. @end deffn
  8198. @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
  8199. eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
  8200. data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
  8201. is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
  8202. peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
  8203. formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
  8204. fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
  8205. can be collected.
  8206. OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
  8207. needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
  8208. tooling.
  8209. @quotation Issues
  8210. OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
  8211. for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
  8212. which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
  8213. @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
  8214. It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
  8215. responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
  8216. managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
  8217. software operation on the CPU.
  8218. @end quotation
  8219. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
  8220. Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
  8221. option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
  8222. is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
  8223. @end deffn
  8224. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
  8225. Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
  8226. @end deffn
  8227. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  8228. Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
  8229. control is disabled.
  8230. @end deffn
  8231. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
  8232. Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
  8233. must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
  8234. to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
  8235. Supported trace formats:
  8236. @itemize
  8237. @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
  8238. timing to be determined.
  8239. @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
  8240. addresses.
  8241. @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
  8242. @end itemize
  8243. @end deffn
  8244. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
  8245. Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
  8246. brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
  8247. these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
  8248. Supported conditions:
  8249. @itemize
  8250. @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
  8251. @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
  8252. @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
  8253. instruction matches start data and mask.
  8254. @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
  8255. instruction matches start data and mask.
  8256. @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
  8257. data and mask.
  8258. @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
  8259. @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
  8260. @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
  8261. @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
  8262. @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
  8263. @end itemize
  8264. @end deffn
  8265. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
  8266. Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
  8267. description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
  8268. values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
  8269. Supported conditions:
  8270. @itemize
  8271. @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
  8272. @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
  8273. @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
  8274. instruction matches stop data and mask.
  8275. @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
  8276. instruction matches stop data and mask.
  8277. @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
  8278. data and mask.
  8279. @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
  8280. @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
  8281. @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
  8282. @end itemize
  8283. @end deffn
  8284. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
  8285. Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
  8286. Supported triggers:
  8287. @itemize
  8288. @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
  8289. @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
  8290. @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
  8291. @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
  8292. collection.
  8293. @end itemize
  8294. @end deffn
  8295. @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
  8296. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
  8297. Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
  8298. configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
  8299. be overwritten when trace collection starts.
  8300. @end deffn
  8301. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
  8302. Display trace configuration.
  8303. @end deffn
  8304. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
  8305. Display trace collection status.
  8306. @end deffn
  8307. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
  8308. Start manual trace collection.
  8309. @end deffn
  8310. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
  8311. Stop manual trace collection.
  8312. @end deffn
  8313. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
  8314. Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
  8315. has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
  8316. copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
  8317. @option{size} options using DMA.
  8318. @end deffn
  8319. @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
  8320. Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
  8321. buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
  8322. be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
  8323. @option{size} options using DMA.
  8324. @end deffn
  8325. @section Intel Architecture
  8326. Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
  8327. (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
  8328. Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
  8329. software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
  8330. Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
  8331. @itemize
  8332. @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
  8333. @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
  8334. @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
  8335. @end itemize
  8336. @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
  8337. The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
  8338. These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
  8339. @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
  8340. Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  8341. @end deffn
  8342. @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
  8343. Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  8344. @end deffn
  8345. @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
  8346. Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  8347. @end deffn
  8348. @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
  8349. Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  8350. @end deffn
  8351. @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
  8352. Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  8353. @end deffn
  8354. @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
  8355. Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
  8356. @end deffn
  8357. @section OpenRISC Architecture
  8358. The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
  8359. configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
  8360. @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
  8361. @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
  8362. Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
  8363. @end deffn
  8364. @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
  8365. Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
  8366. An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
  8367. When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
  8368. configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
  8369. between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
  8370. @end deffn
  8371. @subsection Registers commands
  8372. @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
  8373. Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
  8374. included in the generated target descriptor file.
  8375. @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
  8376. @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
  8377. "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
  8378. and "timer" groups.
  8379. @emph{example:}
  8380. @example
  8381. addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
  8382. @end example
  8383. @end deffn
  8384. @deffn {Command} {readgroup} (@option{group})
  8385. Display all registers in @emph{group}.
  8386. @emph{group} can be "system",
  8387. "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
  8388. "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
  8389. @end deffn
  8390. @section RISC-V Architecture
  8391. @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
  8392. debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
  8393. harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
  8394. RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
  8395. Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
  8396. implement version 0.11.
  8397. @subsection RISC-V Terminology
  8398. A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
  8399. another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
  8400. OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
  8401. @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
  8402. @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
  8403. Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
  8404. standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
  8405. By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
  8406. and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
  8407. command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
  8408. CSRs.
  8409. @end deffn
  8410. @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
  8411. The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
  8412. through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
  8413. configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
  8414. indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
  8415. This command must be executed before `init`.
  8416. @end deffn
  8417. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
  8418. Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
  8419. should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
  8420. @end deffn
  8421. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
  8422. Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
  8423. deasserted.
  8424. @end deffn
  8425. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
  8426. Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
  8427. This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
  8428. @end deffn
  8429. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
  8430. When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
  8431. prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
  8432. @end deffn
  8433. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
  8434. When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
  8435. on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
  8436. on physical memory.
  8437. @end deffn
  8438. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
  8439. When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
  8440. depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
  8441. performed on physical memory.
  8442. @end deffn
  8443. @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
  8444. Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
  8445. software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
  8446. that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
  8447. harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
  8448. race condition problem in your code.
  8449. Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
  8450. behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
  8451. @end deffn
  8452. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
  8453. Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
  8454. example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
  8455. way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
  8456. values.
  8457. When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
  8458. @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
  8459. and DBUS registers, respectively.
  8460. @end deffn
  8461. @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
  8462. Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
  8463. the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
  8464. @end deffn
  8465. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
  8466. Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
  8467. OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
  8468. @end deffn
  8469. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
  8470. Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
  8471. OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
  8472. @end deffn
  8473. @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
  8474. Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
  8475. OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
  8476. @end deffn
  8477. @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
  8478. The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
  8479. trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
  8480. configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
  8481. @example
  8482. set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
  8483. riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
  8484. @end example
  8485. @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
  8486. Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
  8487. @end deffn
  8488. @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
  8489. Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
  8490. @end deffn
  8491. @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
  8492. The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
  8493. can be used to interact with custom debug features.
  8494. @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
  8495. Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
  8496. @end deffn
  8497. @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
  8498. Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
  8499. @end deffn
  8500. @section ARC Architecture
  8501. @cindex ARC
  8502. Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
  8503. designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
  8504. high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
  8505. at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
  8506. OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
  8507. There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
  8508. access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
  8509. configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
  8510. capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
  8511. extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
  8512. instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
  8513. registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
  8514. model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
  8515. describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
  8516. those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
  8517. @subsection General ARC commands
  8518. @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
  8519. Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
  8520. marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
  8521. arguments:
  8522. @itemize @bullet
  8523. @item @code{-name} name
  8524. @*Name of a register.
  8525. @item @code{-num} number
  8526. @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
  8527. @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
  8528. @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
  8529. @end itemize
  8530. @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
  8531. @itemize @bullet
  8532. @item @code{-gdbnum} number
  8533. @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
  8534. manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
  8535. number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
  8536. will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
  8537. registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
  8538. @item @code{-core}
  8539. @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
  8540. AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
  8541. spaces.
  8542. @item @code{-bcr}
  8543. @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
  8544. Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
  8545. only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
  8546. never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
  8547. type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
  8548. @item @code{-type} type_name
  8549. @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
  8550. or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
  8551. @item @code{-g}
  8552. @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
  8553. read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
  8554. transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
  8555. non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
  8556. is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
  8557. @end itemize
  8558. @end deffn
  8559. @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
  8560. Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
  8561. one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
  8562. @end deffn
  8563. @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
  8564. @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
  8565. Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
  8566. bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
  8567. supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
  8568. startbit endbit}.
  8569. @end deffn
  8570. @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
  8571. Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
  8572. type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
  8573. @end deffn
  8574. @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
  8575. Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
  8576. as an argument for a single command invocation.
  8577. @end deffn
  8578. @subsection ARC JTAG commands
  8579. @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
  8580. This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
  8581. register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
  8582. therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
  8583. @end deffn
  8584. @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
  8585. This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
  8586. registers.
  8587. @end deffn
  8588. @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
  8589. This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
  8590. register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
  8591. therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
  8592. @end deffn
  8593. @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
  8594. This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
  8595. registers.
  8596. @end deffn
  8597. @section STM8 Architecture
  8598. @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
  8599. STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
  8600. OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
  8601. protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
  8602. @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
  8603. @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
  8604. @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
  8605. @cindex tracing
  8606. @cindex libdcc
  8607. @cindex DCC
  8608. OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
  8609. the target uses appropriate libraries.
  8610. The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
  8611. a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
  8612. Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
  8613. is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
  8614. These messages are received as part of target polling, so
  8615. you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
  8616. They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
  8617. times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
  8618. See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
  8619. In addition to sending strings, characters, and
  8620. arrays of various size integers from the target,
  8621. @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
  8622. The target being debugged may
  8623. issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
  8624. Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
  8625. each supported by a command:
  8626. @itemize
  8627. @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
  8628. can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
  8629. This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
  8630. finding out how some fault was triggered.
  8631. The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
  8632. It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
  8633. particular event, and other bits to hold data.
  8634. @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
  8635. and then displayed at any time.
  8636. This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
  8637. The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
  8638. number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
  8639. @end itemize
  8640. Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
  8641. via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
  8642. depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
  8643. deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
  8644. This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
  8645. Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
  8646. does the same thing.
  8647. @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
  8648. Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
  8649. These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
  8650. The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
  8651. both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
  8652. With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
  8653. as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
  8654. otherwise the libdcc format is used.
  8655. @end deffn
  8656. @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
  8657. With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
  8658. in the order they triggered.
  8659. With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
  8660. With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
  8661. history records.
  8662. @end deffn
  8663. @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
  8664. With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
  8665. they have been triggered.
  8666. With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
  8667. With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
  8668. and associates it with that identifier.
  8669. @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
  8670. are not related except by this command.
  8671. These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
  8672. or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
  8673. @end deffn
  8674. @node JTAG Commands
  8675. @chapter JTAG Commands
  8676. @cindex JTAG Commands
  8677. Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
  8678. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
  8679. Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
  8680. may be needed to work with targets which require special
  8681. attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
  8682. To use these commands you will need to understand some
  8683. of the basics of JTAG, including:
  8684. @itemize @bullet
  8685. @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
  8686. devices such as a CPUs.
  8687. @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
  8688. standard state machine (in parallel)
  8689. using their shared TMS and clock signals.
  8690. @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
  8691. instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
  8692. while the reading previous ones.
  8693. @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
  8694. a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
  8695. All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
  8696. @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
  8697. shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
  8698. registers.
  8699. @end itemize
  8700. @section Low Level JTAG Commands
  8701. These commands are used by developers who need to access
  8702. JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
  8703. the order of TAP state transitions.
  8704. If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
  8705. new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
  8706. JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
  8707. In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
  8708. these commands are not available.
  8709. @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
  8710. Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
  8711. that specify the entire register.
  8712. Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
  8713. a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
  8714. The return value holds the original value of each
  8715. of those fields.
  8716. For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
  8717. field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
  8718. @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
  8719. than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
  8720. support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
  8721. All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
  8722. The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
  8723. When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
  8724. in that state.
  8725. For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
  8726. instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
  8727. If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
  8728. @quotation Warning
  8729. OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
  8730. so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
  8731. Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
  8732. data registers, which may have different lengths.
  8733. Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
  8734. the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
  8735. the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
  8736. (by connecting a different scan chain).
  8737. @end quotation
  8738. @end deffn
  8739. @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
  8740. Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
  8741. This may be used for performance tuning.
  8742. For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
  8743. minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
  8744. not change with the amount of data which is written.
  8745. You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
  8746. tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
  8747. instead of batching them into larger operations.
  8748. @end deffn
  8749. @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
  8750. For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
  8751. with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
  8752. (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
  8753. using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
  8754. For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
  8755. When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
  8756. in that state.
  8757. For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
  8758. can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
  8759. If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
  8760. @quotation Note
  8761. OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
  8762. register values, unlike data register values.
  8763. For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
  8764. portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
  8765. @end quotation
  8766. @end deffn
  8767. @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
  8768. Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
  8769. must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
  8770. Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
  8771. current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
  8772. Then, in a series of single state transitions
  8773. (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
  8774. each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
  8775. The final state must also be stable.
  8776. @end deffn
  8777. @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
  8778. Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
  8779. @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
  8780. Instructions often need some time
  8781. to execute before they take effect.
  8782. @end deffn
  8783. @c tms_sequence (short|long)
  8784. @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
  8785. @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  8786. Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
  8787. during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
  8788. overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
  8789. This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
  8790. @end deffn
  8791. @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
  8792. Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
  8793. programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
  8794. must also be enabled.
  8795. Default is enabled.
  8796. @end deffn
  8797. @section TAP state names
  8798. @cindex TAP state names
  8799. The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
  8800. @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
  8801. as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
  8802. SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
  8803. @itemize @bullet
  8804. @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
  8805. acts as if TRST were pulsed
  8806. @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
  8807. @item @b{DRSELECT}
  8808. @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
  8809. @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
  8810. through the data register
  8811. @item @b{DREXIT1}
  8812. @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
  8813. for update or more shifting
  8814. @item @b{DREXIT2}
  8815. @item @b{DRUPDATE}
  8816. @item @b{IRSELECT}
  8817. @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
  8818. @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
  8819. through the instruction register
  8820. @item @b{IREXIT1}
  8821. @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
  8822. for update or more shifting
  8823. @item @b{IREXIT2}
  8824. @item @b{IRUPDATE}
  8825. @end itemize
  8826. Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
  8827. face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
  8828. and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
  8829. others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
  8830. @itemize @bullet
  8831. @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
  8832. produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
  8833. to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
  8834. may not be as expected.
  8835. @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
  8836. choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
  8837. since they are free of JTAG side effects.
  8838. @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
  8839. levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
  8840. Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
  8841. @end itemize
  8842. @node Boundary Scan Commands
  8843. @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
  8844. One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
  8845. boundary scan based hardware testing.
  8846. Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
  8847. OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
  8848. @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
  8849. @cindex Serial Vector Format
  8850. @cindex SVF
  8851. The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
  8852. way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
  8853. In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
  8854. OpenOCD supports running such test files.
  8855. @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
  8856. [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
  8857. This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
  8858. runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
  8859. Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
  8860. affect their semantics.
  8861. Command options:
  8862. @itemize @minus
  8863. @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
  8864. specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
  8865. instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
  8866. chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
  8867. @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
  8868. @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
  8869. on the real interface;
  8870. @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
  8871. @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
  8872. errors.
  8873. @end itemize
  8874. @end deffn
  8875. @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
  8876. @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
  8877. @cindex XSVF
  8878. The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
  8879. binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
  8880. Xilinx devices.
  8881. In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
  8882. OpenOCD supports running such test files.
  8883. @quotation Important
  8884. Not all XSVF commands are supported.
  8885. @end quotation
  8886. @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
  8887. This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
  8888. runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
  8889. When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
  8890. that TAP.
  8891. When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
  8892. are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
  8893. Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
  8894. messages are logged for comments and some retries.
  8895. @end deffn
  8896. The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
  8897. for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
  8898. after building the software.
  8899. You may find them useful:
  8900. @itemize
  8901. @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
  8902. syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
  8903. @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
  8904. understands the OpenOCD extensions.
  8905. @end itemize
  8906. The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
  8907. These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
  8908. from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
  8909. two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
  8910. (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
  8911. If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
  8912. probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
  8913. @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
  8914. @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
  8915. @cindex IPDBG
  8916. IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
  8917. waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
  8918. logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
  8919. In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
  8920. of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
  8921. control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
  8922. @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
  8923. Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
  8924. Command options:
  8925. @itemize @bullet
  8926. @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
  8927. @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
  8928. @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
  8929. reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
  8930. @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
  8931. @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
  8932. @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
  8933. specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
  8934. access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
  8935. parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
  8936. shift data through vir can be configured.
  8937. @end itemize
  8938. @end deffn
  8939. Examples:
  8940. @example
  8941. ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
  8942. @end example
  8943. Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
  8944. The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
  8945. @example
  8946. ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
  8947. @end example
  8948. Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
  8949. The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
  8950. @node Utility Commands
  8951. @chapter Utility Commands
  8952. @cindex Utility Commands
  8953. @section RAM testing
  8954. @cindex RAM testing
  8955. There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
  8956. errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
  8957. testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
  8958. electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
  8959. hardware problems.
  8960. To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
  8961. consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
  8962. register operations and translate them to the corresponding
  8963. @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
  8964. Load the memory testing functions with
  8965. @example
  8966. source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
  8967. @end example
  8968. to get access to the following facilities:
  8969. @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
  8970. Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
  8971. 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
  8972. @end deffn
  8973. @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
  8974. Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
  8975. check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
  8976. such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
  8977. @end deffn
  8978. @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
  8979. Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
  8980. increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
  8981. storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
  8982. @end deffn
  8983. @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
  8984. Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
  8985. @end deffn
  8986. @section Firmware recovery helpers
  8987. @cindex Firmware recovery
  8988. OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
  8989. devices recovery with JTAG.
  8990. For quickstart instructions run:
  8991. @example
  8992. openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
  8993. @end example
  8994. @node GDB and OpenOCD
  8995. @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
  8996. @cindex GDB
  8997. OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
  8998. to debug remote targets.
  8999. Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
  9000. @itemize
  9001. @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
  9002. @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
  9003. @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
  9004. as shown in this chapter.
  9005. @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
  9006. that also will probably need to be configured.
  9007. @end itemize
  9008. Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
  9009. been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
  9010. part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
  9011. cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
  9012. x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
  9013. if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
  9014. @section Connecting to GDB
  9015. @cindex Connecting to GDB
  9016. Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
  9017. instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
  9018. errors, which has since been fixed; see
  9019. @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
  9020. OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
  9021. @enumerate
  9022. @item
  9023. A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
  9024. @example
  9025. target extended-remote localhost:3333
  9026. @end example
  9027. This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
  9028. The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
  9029. be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
  9030. @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
  9031. To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
  9032. remote command above that becomes:
  9033. @example
  9034. tar ext :3333
  9035. @end example
  9036. @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
  9037. protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
  9038. available through the command:
  9039. @example
  9040. target remote localhost:3333
  9041. @end example
  9042. @item
  9043. A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
  9044. @example
  9045. target extended-remote | \
  9046. openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
  9047. @end example
  9048. This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
  9049. Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
  9050. session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
  9051. not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
  9052. @end enumerate
  9053. To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
  9054. GDB command line.
  9055. @section Sample GDB session startup
  9056. With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
  9057. than they do when you're debugging locally.
  9058. Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
  9059. small ARM program.
  9060. In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
  9061. Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
  9062. @example
  9063. $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
  9064. (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
  9065. Remote debugging using localhost:3333
  9066. ...
  9067. (gdb) monitor reset halt
  9068. ...
  9069. (gdb) load
  9070. Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
  9071. Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
  9072. Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
  9073. Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
  9074. Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
  9075. (gdb) continue
  9076. Continuing.
  9077. ...
  9078. @end example
  9079. You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
  9080. type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
  9081. code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
  9082. set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
  9083. @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
  9084. OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
  9085. to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
  9086. packet size and the device's memory map.
  9087. You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
  9088. and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
  9089. set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
  9090. However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
  9091. You may need to set those up by hand.
  9092. As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
  9093. something like:
  9094. @example
  9095. Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
  9096. @end example
  9097. You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
  9098. @example
  9099. set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
  9100. set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
  9101. @end example
  9102. With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
  9103. only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
  9104. do not have such restrictions.
  9105. Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
  9106. save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
  9107. using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
  9108. using @command{gdb -x filename}.
  9109. @section Programming using GDB
  9110. @cindex Programming using GDB
  9111. @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
  9112. By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
  9113. the following OpenOCD configuration option:
  9114. @example
  9115. gdb_memory_map disable
  9116. @end example
  9117. For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
  9118. in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
  9119. working area.
  9120. Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
  9121. flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
  9122. that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
  9123. using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
  9124. To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
  9125. All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
  9126. GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
  9127. This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
  9128. @example
  9129. set mem inaccessible-by-default off
  9130. @end example
  9131. If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
  9132. program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
  9133. GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
  9134. areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
  9135. will be used.
  9136. If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
  9137. event gdb-flash-erase-start:
  9138. @example
  9139. $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
  9140. @end example
  9141. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
  9142. To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
  9143. can be used.
  9144. @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
  9145. @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
  9146. @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
  9147. If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
  9148. robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
  9149. just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
  9150. OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
  9151. Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
  9152. and GDB treats it as it were running.
  9153. If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
  9154. you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
  9155. without any intrusion of the target process.
  9156. Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
  9157. Place following command after target configuration:
  9158. @example
  9159. $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
  9160. @end example
  9161. If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
  9162. switch off gdb_memory_map:
  9163. @example
  9164. gdb_memory_map disable
  9165. @end example
  9166. Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
  9167. Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
  9168. @example
  9169. set remote interrupt-on-connect off
  9170. @end example
  9171. If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
  9172. manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
  9173. Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
  9174. of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
  9175. @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
  9176. and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
  9177. Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
  9178. previously shown variables.
  9179. It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
  9180. target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
  9181. example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
  9182. while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
  9183. because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
  9184. @section RTOS Support
  9185. @cindex RTOS Support
  9186. @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
  9187. OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
  9188. It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
  9189. @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
  9190. Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
  9191. GDB commands.
  9192. @* An example setup is below:
  9193. @example
  9194. $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
  9195. @end example
  9196. This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
  9197. Currently supported rtos's include:
  9198. @itemize @bullet
  9199. @item @option{eCos}
  9200. @item @option{ThreadX}
  9201. @item @option{FreeRTOS}
  9202. @item @option{linux}
  9203. @item @option{ChibiOS}
  9204. @item @option{embKernel}
  9205. @item @option{mqx}
  9206. @item @option{uCOS-III}
  9207. @item @option{nuttx}
  9208. @item @option{RIOT}
  9209. @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
  9210. @item @option{Zephyr}
  9211. @end itemize
  9212. Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
  9213. be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
  9214. @table @code
  9215. @item eCos symbols
  9216. Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
  9217. @item ThreadX symbols
  9218. _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
  9219. @item FreeRTOS symbols
  9220. @raggedright
  9221. pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
  9222. pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
  9223. uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
  9224. @end raggedright
  9225. @item linux symbols
  9226. init_task.
  9227. @item ChibiOS symbols
  9228. rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
  9229. @item embKernel symbols
  9230. Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
  9231. Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
  9232. @item mqx symbols
  9233. _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
  9234. @item uC/OS-III symbols
  9235. OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
  9236. @item nuttx symbols
  9237. g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
  9238. @item RIOT symbols
  9239. @raggedright
  9240. sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
  9241. _tcb_name_offset.
  9242. @end raggedright
  9243. @item Zephyr symbols
  9244. _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
  9245. @end table
  9246. For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
  9247. some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
  9248. Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
  9249. with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
  9250. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
  9251. along with the project:
  9252. @table @code
  9253. @item FreeRTOS
  9254. contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
  9255. @item uC/OS-III
  9256. contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
  9257. @end table
  9258. @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
  9259. @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
  9260. @cindex SMP
  9261. @cindex RTOS
  9262. @cindex hwthread
  9263. OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
  9264. ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
  9265. GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
  9266. After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
  9267. list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
  9268. command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
  9269. The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
  9270. while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
  9271. scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
  9272. @section Legacy SMP core switching support
  9273. @quotation Note
  9274. This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
  9275. @end quotation
  9276. For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
  9277. @itemize @bullet
  9278. @item j - smp status request
  9279. @item J - smp set request
  9280. @end itemize
  9281. OpenOCD implements :
  9282. @itemize @bullet
  9283. @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
  9284. GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
  9285. @option{E01} for target not smp.
  9286. @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
  9287. (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
  9288. for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
  9289. @end itemize
  9290. Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
  9291. @itemize @bullet
  9292. @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
  9293. of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
  9294. @example
  9295. set $_core 1
  9296. #Jc01 packet is sent
  9297. print $_core
  9298. #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
  9299. @end example
  9300. @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
  9301. core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
  9302. @example
  9303. # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
  9304. define toggle0
  9305. maint packet Jc0
  9306. continue
  9307. main packet Jc-1
  9308. end
  9309. # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
  9310. define toggle1
  9311. maint packet Jc1
  9312. continue
  9313. main packet Jc-1
  9314. end
  9315. @end example
  9316. @end itemize
  9317. @node Tcl Scripting API
  9318. @chapter Tcl Scripting API
  9319. @cindex Tcl Scripting API
  9320. @cindex Tcl scripts
  9321. @section API rules
  9322. Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
  9323. a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
  9324. of state information as an argument to each proc.
  9325. There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
  9326. pair list and lists.
  9327. Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
  9328. list.
  9329. @example
  9330. > set foo(me) Duane
  9331. > set foo(you) Oyvind
  9332. > set foo(mouse) Micky
  9333. > set foo(duck) Donald
  9334. @end example
  9335. If one does this:
  9336. @example
  9337. > set foo
  9338. @end example
  9339. The result is:
  9340. @example
  9341. me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
  9342. @end example
  9343. Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
  9344. @verbatim
  9345. foreach { name value } [set foo] {
  9346. puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
  9347. }
  9348. @end verbatim
  9349. Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
  9350. should be passed in to the proc in question.
  9351. @section Internal low-level Commands
  9352. By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
  9353. invoke directly.
  9354. @itemize @bullet
  9355. @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
  9356. Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
  9357. @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
  9358. Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
  9359. @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
  9360. Return information about the flash banks
  9361. @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
  9362. Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
  9363. its execution. Example:
  9364. @example
  9365. > capture "reset init"
  9366. @end example
  9367. @end itemize
  9368. OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
  9369. @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
  9370. called "flash_banks".
  9371. @section Tcl RPC server
  9372. @cindex RPC
  9373. OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
  9374. commands and receive the results.
  9375. To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
  9376. (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
  9377. interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
  9378. value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
  9379. repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
  9380. It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
  9381. @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
  9382. @command{capture} command.
  9383. See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
  9384. @section Tcl RPC server notifications
  9385. @cindex RPC Notifications
  9386. Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
  9387. the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
  9388. Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
  9389. in the following format.
  9390. @verbatim
  9391. type target_event event [event-name]
  9392. type target_state state [state-name]
  9393. type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
  9394. @end verbatim
  9395. @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
  9396. Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
  9397. Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
  9398. Defaults to off.
  9399. @end deffn
  9400. @section Tcl RPC server trace output
  9401. @cindex RPC trace output
  9402. Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
  9403. the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
  9404. Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
  9405. @verbatim
  9406. type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
  9407. @end verbatim
  9408. @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
  9409. Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
  9410. Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
  9411. Defaults to off.
  9412. See an example application here:
  9413. @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
  9414. @end deffn
  9415. @node FAQ
  9416. @chapter FAQ
  9417. @cindex faq
  9418. @enumerate
  9419. @anchor{faqrtck}
  9420. @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
  9421. @cindex RTCK
  9422. @cindex adaptive clocking
  9423. @*
  9424. In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
  9425. synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
  9426. operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
  9427. The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
  9428. In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
  9429. well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
  9430. for example. There are 2 basic options:
  9431. @enumerate
  9432. @item
  9433. Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
  9434. clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
  9435. @item
  9436. The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
  9437. the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
  9438. @end enumerate
  9439. @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
  9440. is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
  9441. the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
  9442. Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
  9443. situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
  9444. power).
  9445. For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
  9446. a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
  9447. and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
  9448. ARM926 scenario).
  9449. If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
  9450. the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
  9451. JTAG can use a faster clock.
  9452. Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
  9453. device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
  9454. clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
  9455. that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
  9456. @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
  9457. In order to make use of this,
  9458. your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
  9459. feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
  9460. The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
  9461. this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
  9462. this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
  9463. 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
  9464. work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
  9465. The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
  9466. held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
  9467. time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
  9468. down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
  9469. Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
  9470. when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
  9471. Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
  9472. both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
  9473. with a CPLD.
  9474. It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
  9475. to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
  9476. back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
  9477. Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
  9478. for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
  9479. @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
  9480. @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
  9481. Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
  9482. In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
  9483. the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
  9484. depending on the chips on your board.
  9485. @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
  9486. ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
  9487. @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
  9488. Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
  9489. maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
  9490. often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
  9491. You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
  9492. either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
  9493. manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
  9494. and tedious, and is not always practical.)
  9495. It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
  9496. have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
  9497. sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
  9498. this way.
  9499. Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
  9500. operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
  9501. clock rate.
  9502. That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
  9503. prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
  9504. cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
  9505. To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
  9506. @example
  9507. # Example: 1.234MHz
  9508. adapter speed 1234
  9509. @end example
  9510. @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
  9511. OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
  9512. around Windows filenames.
  9513. @example
  9514. > echo \a
  9515. > echo @{\a@}
  9516. \a
  9517. > echo "\a"
  9518. >
  9519. @end example
  9520. @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
  9521. Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
  9522. claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
  9523. OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
  9524. @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
  9525. Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
  9526. arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
  9527. GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
  9528. source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
  9529. software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
  9530. @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
  9531. Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
  9532. clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
  9533. frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
  9534. (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
  9535. @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
  9536. I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
  9537. out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
  9538. Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
  9539. settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
  9540. @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
  9541. I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
  9542. memory read caused data abort".
  9543. The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
  9544. beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
  9545. a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
  9546. be done, feel free to add this here.
  9547. @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
  9548. stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
  9549. time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
  9550. call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
  9551. happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
  9552. stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
  9553. gracefully stops.
  9554. @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
  9555. your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
  9556. remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
  9557. @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
  9558. often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
  9559. bytes. Painful...
  9560. @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
  9561. "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
  9562. This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
  9563. debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
  9564. trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
  9565. your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
  9566. independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
  9567. reset, everything else should work fine.
  9568. @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
  9569. toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
  9570. unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
  9571. quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
  9572. No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
  9573. this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
  9574. Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
  9575. supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
  9576. @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
  9577. @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
  9578. error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
  9579. What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
  9580. Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
  9581. has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
  9582. @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
  9583. are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
  9584. for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
  9585. 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
  9586. specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
  9587. frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
  9588. i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
  9589. clock frequency?
  9590. No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
  9591. However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
  9592. routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
  9593. the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
  9594. frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
  9595. @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
  9596. Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
  9597. devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
  9598. order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
  9599. listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
  9600. which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
  9601. right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
  9602. references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
  9603. You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
  9604. Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
  9605. processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
  9606. else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
  9607. up DRAM and loading it with code.
  9608. @anchor{faqtaporder}
  9609. @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
  9610. particular order?
  9611. Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
  9612. the same order used by the hardware.
  9613. Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
  9614. STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
  9615. ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
  9616. RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
  9617. connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
  9618. Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
  9619. Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
  9620. (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
  9621. chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
  9622. place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
  9623. @itemize @bullet
  9624. @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
  9625. @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
  9626. @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
  9627. @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
  9628. @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
  9629. @end itemize
  9630. The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
  9631. @itemize @bullet
  9632. @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
  9633. @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
  9634. @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
  9635. @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
  9636. @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
  9637. @end itemize
  9638. @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
  9639. log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
  9640. arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
  9641. TODO.
  9642. @end enumerate
  9643. @node Tcl Crash Course
  9644. @chapter Tcl Crash Course
  9645. @cindex Tcl
  9646. Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
  9647. learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
  9648. how the Tcl scripts work.
  9649. This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
  9650. who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
  9651. something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
  9652. OpenOCD.
  9653. @section Tcl Rule #1
  9654. There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
  9655. @enumerate
  9656. @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
  9657. @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
  9658. @end enumerate
  9659. The Tcl equal is this:
  9660. @enumerate
  9661. @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
  9662. @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
  9663. @end enumerate
  9664. As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
  9665. you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
  9666. @section Tcl Rule #1b
  9667. There is a second pair of rules.
  9668. @enumerate
  9669. @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
  9670. @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
  9671. flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
  9672. in Tcl.
  9673. @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
  9674. @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
  9675. convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
  9676. those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
  9677. @end enumerate
  9678. @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
  9679. Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
  9680. deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
  9681. Everything is a string}
  9682. @section Tcl Quoting Operators
  9683. In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
  9684. difference is subtle.
  9685. @enumerate
  9686. @item Parse Time
  9687. @item Evaluation Time
  9688. @end enumerate
  9689. The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
  9690. three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
  9691. @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
  9692. By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
  9693. sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
  9694. in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
  9695. = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
  9696. @itemize @bullet
  9697. @item @b{[square-brackets]}
  9698. @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
  9699. like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
  9700. operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
  9701. string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
  9702. @example
  9703. # bash example
  9704. X=`date`
  9705. echo "The Date is: $X"
  9706. # Tcl example
  9707. set X [date]
  9708. puts "The Date is: $X"
  9709. @end example
  9710. @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
  9711. @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
  9712. text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
  9713. result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
  9714. is a string}
  9715. @example
  9716. set x "Dinner"
  9717. puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
  9718. @end example
  9719. @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
  9720. @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
  9721. parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
  9722. 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
  9723. feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
  9724. nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
  9725. at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
  9726. @end itemize
  9727. @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
  9728. The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
  9729. @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
  9730. Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
  9731. the normal way.
  9732. As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
  9733. tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
  9734. line is immediately executed.
  9735. Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
  9736. @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
  9737. @subsection Command Execution
  9738. Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
  9739. statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
  9740. control flow operators.
  9741. Commands are executed like this:
  9742. @enumerate
  9743. @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
  9744. @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
  9745. @item Repeat until End Of File.
  9746. @end enumerate
  9747. It sort of works like this:
  9748. @example
  9749. for(;;)@{
  9750. ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
  9751. cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
  9752. (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
  9753. @}
  9754. @end example
  9755. When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
  9756. function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
  9757. the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
  9758. of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
  9759. command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
  9760. ``LookupCommand()''
  9761. @subsection The FOR command
  9762. The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
  9763. the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
  9764. command just like any other command.
  9765. When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
  9766. produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
  9767. are:
  9768. @enumerate 0
  9769. @item The ascii text 'for'
  9770. @item The start text
  9771. @item The test expression
  9772. @item The next text
  9773. @item The body text
  9774. @end enumerate
  9775. Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
  9776. Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
  9777. Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
  9778. variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
  9779. Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
  9780. argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
  9781. @example
  9782. int
  9783. MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
  9784. int *argc,
  9785. Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
  9786. @end example
  9787. Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
  9788. introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
  9789. still operates in the same basic way.
  9790. @subsection FOR command implementation
  9791. To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
  9792. command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
  9793. In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
  9794. Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
  9795. The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
  9796. string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
  9797. parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
  9798. The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
  9799. expression and returns a value.
  9800. Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
  9801. implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
  9802. @example
  9803. void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
  9804. int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
  9805. int
  9806. MyForCommand( void *interp,
  9807. int argc,
  9808. char **argv )
  9809. @{
  9810. if( argc != 5 )@{
  9811. SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
  9812. return ERROR;
  9813. @}
  9814. // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
  9815. // Execute the start statement.
  9816. Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
  9817. // Top of loop test
  9818. for(;;)@{
  9819. i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
  9820. if( i == 0 )
  9821. break;
  9822. // Execute the body
  9823. Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
  9824. // Execute the LOOP part
  9825. Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
  9826. @}
  9827. // Return no error
  9828. SetResult( interp, "" );
  9829. return SUCCESS;
  9830. @}
  9831. @end example
  9832. Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
  9833. in the same basic way.
  9834. @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
  9835. @subsection source and find commands
  9836. @b{Where:} In many configuration files
  9837. @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
  9838. @*Remember the parsing rules
  9839. @enumerate
  9840. @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
  9841. and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
  9842. the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
  9843. The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
  9844. place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
  9845. (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
  9846. That character begins Tcl comments.)
  9847. @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
  9848. it reads a file and executes as a script.
  9849. @end enumerate
  9850. @subsection format command
  9851. @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
  9852. @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
  9853. @b{sprintf()}.
  9854. @b{Example}
  9855. @example
  9856. set x 6
  9857. set y 7
  9858. puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
  9859. @end example
  9860. @enumerate
  9861. @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
  9862. @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
  9863. @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
  9864. @* Refer to Rule #1
  9865. @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
  9866. @* Refer to Rule #1.
  9867. @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
  9868. @end enumerate
  9869. @subsection Body or Inlined Text
  9870. @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
  9871. @example
  9872. #1 Good
  9873. proc someproc @{@} @{
  9874. ... multiple lines of stuff ...
  9875. @}
  9876. $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
  9877. #2 Good - no variables
  9878. $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
  9879. #3 Good Curly Braces
  9880. $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
  9881. puts "Time: [date]"
  9882. @}
  9883. #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
  9884. $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
  9885. @end example
  9886. @enumerate
  9887. @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
  9888. @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
  9889. each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
  9890. the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
  9891. the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
  9892. command.
  9893. @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
  9894. @*There are 4 examples:
  9895. @enumerate
  9896. @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
  9897. @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
  9898. @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
  9899. @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
  9900. @end enumerate
  9901. In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
  9902. evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
  9903. Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
  9904. Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
  9905. $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
  9906. and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
  9907. ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
  9908. $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
  9909. change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
  9910. Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
  9911. @end enumerate
  9912. @subsection Global Variables
  9913. @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
  9914. simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
  9915. you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
  9916. @example
  9917. proc myproc @{ @} @{
  9918. set y 0 #Local variable Y
  9919. global x #Global variable X
  9920. puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
  9921. @}
  9922. @end example
  9923. @section Other Tcl Hacks
  9924. @b{Dynamic variable creation}
  9925. @example
  9926. # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
  9927. for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
  9928. # Create var name
  9929. set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
  9930. # Make it a global
  9931. global $vn
  9932. # Set it.
  9933. set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
  9934. @}
  9935. @end example
  9936. @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
  9937. @example
  9938. # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
  9939. foreach who @{A B C D E@}
  9940. proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
  9941. @}
  9942. @end example
  9943. @node License
  9944. @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
  9945. @include fdl.texi
  9946. @node OpenOCD Concept Index
  9947. @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
  9948. @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
  9949. @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
  9950. @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
  9951. @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
  9952. @printindex cp
  9953. @node Command and Driver Index
  9954. @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
  9955. @printindex fn
  9956. @bye